4 @settitle T-gnus 6.15 Manual
10 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
15 @setchapternewpage odd
19 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
20 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
21 \usepackage{pagestyle}
24 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
26 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
28 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
36 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Oort Gnus v0.06}
37 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
38 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
40 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
42 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
43 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
44 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
46 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
48 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
49 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
51 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
52 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
54 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
55 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
56 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
57 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
59 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
60 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
61 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
62 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
63 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
64 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
65 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
67 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
73 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
74 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
75 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
76 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
77 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
78 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
79 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
85 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
87 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
90 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
92 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
99 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
101 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
103 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
104 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
105 \thispagestyle{empty}
107 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
108 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
109 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
114 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
116 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
123 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
124 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
127 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
128 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
131 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
132 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
135 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
136 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
139 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
141 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
142 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
146 \newenvironment{codelist}%
151 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
157 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
162 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
167 \newenvironment{samplist}%
172 \newenvironment{varlist}%
177 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
182 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
183 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
184 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
186 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
191 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
195 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
204 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
206 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
211 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
216 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
220 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
228 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
230 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
240 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
244 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
252 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
254 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \pagenumbering{roman}
260 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
270 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
271 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
273 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
275 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
278 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
281 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
288 \thispagestyle{empty}
290 Copyright \copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
291 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
294 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
295 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
296 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
297 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
298 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
299 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
300 License'' in the Emacs manual.
302 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
303 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
304 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
306 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
307 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
308 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
309 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
317 This file documents gnus, the GNU Emacs newsreader.
319 Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
320 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
322 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
323 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
324 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
325 Invariant Sections being none, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
326 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
327 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
328 License'' in the Emacs manual.
330 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
331 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
332 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
334 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
335 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
336 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
337 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
343 @title T-gnus 6.15 Manual
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
348 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
349 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
350 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
352 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
353 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
354 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
355 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
356 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
357 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
358 License'' in the Emacs manual.
360 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
361 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
362 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
364 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
365 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
366 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
367 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
376 @top The gnus Newsreader
380 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using gnus. The news
381 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@sc{nntp}, local
382 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
385 T-gnus provides @sc{mime} features based on @sc{semi} API. So T-gnus
386 supports your right to read strange messages including big images or
387 other various kinds of formats. T-gnus also supports
388 internationalization/localization and multiscript features based on MULE
389 API. So T-gnus does not discriminate various language communities.
390 Oh, if you are a Klingon, please wait Unicode Next Generation.
392 This manual corresponds to T-gnus 6.15.
403 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
404 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
406 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
407 being accused of plagiarism:
409 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
410 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
411 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
412 can even read news with it!
414 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
415 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
416 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend gnus to make it behave
417 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
418 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
424 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
425 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
426 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
427 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
428 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
429 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
430 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
431 * Various:: General purpose settings.
432 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
433 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, FAQ, History, Internals.
434 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
435 * Key Index:: Key Index.
438 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
442 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
443 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
444 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
445 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
446 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
447 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
448 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
449 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
450 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
451 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
452 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
456 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
457 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
458 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
462 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
463 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
464 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
465 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
466 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
467 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
468 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
469 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
470 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
471 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
472 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
473 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
474 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
475 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
476 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
477 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
478 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
482 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
483 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
484 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
488 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
489 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
490 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
491 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
492 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
496 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
497 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
498 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
499 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
500 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
504 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
505 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
506 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
507 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
508 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
510 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
511 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
512 * Threading:: How threads are made.
513 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
514 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
515 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
516 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
517 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
518 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
519 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
520 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
521 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
522 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
523 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
524 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
525 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
526 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
527 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
528 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
529 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
530 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
531 or reselecting the current group.
532 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
533 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
534 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
535 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
537 Summary Buffer Format
539 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
540 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
541 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
542 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
546 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
547 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
549 Reply, Followup and Post
551 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
552 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
553 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
554 * Canceling and Superseding::
558 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
559 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
560 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
562 * Generic Marking Commands::
563 * Setting Process Marks::
567 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
568 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
569 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
573 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
574 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
576 Customizing Threading
578 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
579 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
580 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
581 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
585 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
586 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
587 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
588 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
589 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
590 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
594 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
595 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
596 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
600 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
601 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
602 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
603 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
604 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
605 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
606 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
607 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
608 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
609 * Article Miscellania:: Various other stuff.
611 Alternative Approaches
613 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
614 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
616 Various Summary Stuff
618 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
619 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
620 * Summary Generation Commands::
621 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
625 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
626 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
627 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
628 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
629 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
633 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
634 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
635 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
636 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
637 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
638 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
639 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
640 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
644 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
645 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
646 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
647 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
648 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
649 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
650 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
651 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
655 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
656 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
657 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
658 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
659 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
660 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
661 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
665 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
666 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
670 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
671 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
672 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
676 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
677 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
678 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
679 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
680 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
681 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
682 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
683 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
684 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
685 * Washing Mail:: Removing gruft from the mail you get.
686 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
687 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
688 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
692 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
693 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
694 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
696 Choosing a Mail Back End
698 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
699 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
700 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
701 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
702 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
703 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
708 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
709 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
710 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
711 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
712 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
713 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
717 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
718 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
719 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
723 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
724 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
725 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
726 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
727 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
731 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
735 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
736 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
737 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
741 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
742 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
746 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
747 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
748 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
749 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
750 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
751 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
752 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
753 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
754 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
755 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
759 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
760 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
761 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
765 * Group Agent Commands::
766 * Summary Agent Commands::
767 * Server Agent Commands::
771 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
772 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
773 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
774 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
775 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
776 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
777 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
778 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
779 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
780 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
781 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
782 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
783 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
784 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
785 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
786 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
787 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
791 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
792 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
793 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
794 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
798 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
799 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
800 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
804 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
805 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
806 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
807 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
808 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
809 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
810 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
811 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
812 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
813 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
814 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
815 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
816 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
817 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
818 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
819 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
820 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
821 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
822 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
826 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
827 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
828 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
829 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
830 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
831 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
832 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
833 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
837 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
838 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
839 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
840 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
841 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
845 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
846 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
847 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
848 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
849 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
853 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
854 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
855 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
859 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
860 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
861 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
862 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
863 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
864 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
865 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
866 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
867 * Frequently Asked Questions::
871 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
872 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
873 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
874 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
875 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
876 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
877 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
878 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
879 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
883 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
884 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
885 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
886 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
887 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
891 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
892 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
893 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
894 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
898 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
899 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
900 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
901 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
902 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
903 * Group Info:: The group info format.
904 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
905 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
906 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
910 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
911 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
912 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
913 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
914 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
915 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
919 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
920 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
924 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
925 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
931 @chapter Starting gnus
936 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting gnus
937 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
940 @findex gnus-other-frame
941 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
942 If you want to start gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
943 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
945 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
946 variables in your @file{~/.gnus} file. This file is similar to
947 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when gnus starts.
949 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
950 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
953 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
954 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
955 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
956 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
957 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
958 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
959 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
960 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
961 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
962 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
963 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
967 @node Finding the News
968 @section Finding the News
971 @vindex gnus-select-method
973 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where gnus should look for
974 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
975 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
976 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
979 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @sc{nntp} server is where
980 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
983 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
986 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
989 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
992 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
993 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
994 server is running Leafnode; in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
996 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
998 @cindex @sc{nntp} server
999 If this variable is not set, gnus will take a look at the
1000 @code{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1001 gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1002 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter. If
1003 that fails as well, gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs as an @sc{nntp} server. That's a long shot, though.
1005 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1006 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1007 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1008 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1010 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1011 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1012 You can also make gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1013 @sc{nntp} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1014 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), gnus will let you choose between the servers
1015 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1016 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1017 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1018 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1021 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1023 However, if you use one @sc{nntp} server regularly and are just
1024 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1025 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1026 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1027 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1028 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1030 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1032 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1033 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1034 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1035 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1036 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1037 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1040 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1041 you would typically set this variable to
1044 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1048 @node The First Time
1049 @section The First Time
1050 @cindex first time usage
1052 If no startup files exist, gnus will try to determine what groups should
1053 be subscribed by default.
1055 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1056 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, gnus
1057 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1058 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1061 Since she hasn't, gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1062 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1063 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1065 You'll also be subscribed to the gnus documentation group, which should
1066 help you with most common problems.
1068 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, gnus will just
1069 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1073 @node The Server is Down
1074 @section The Server is Down
1075 @cindex server errors
1077 If the default server is down, gnus will understandably have some
1078 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1079 the news groups, you may want to start gnus anyway.
1081 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1082 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1083 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1084 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1085 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1086 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1087 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1089 @findex gnus-no-server
1090 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1092 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1093 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1094 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start gnus. That might come in handy
1095 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1096 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1097 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1098 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1102 @section Slave Gnusae
1105 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one gnus at the
1106 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1107 are using the two different gnusae to read from two different servers),
1108 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1110 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1111 @code{.newsrc} file.
1113 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the gnus
1114 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1115 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1116 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1117 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1118 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1119 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1121 Anyway, you start one gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1122 however you do it). Each subsequent slave gnusae should be started with
1123 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1124 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1125 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master gnus
1126 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1127 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1128 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1130 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1131 information in the normal (i.e., master) @code{.newsrc} file.
1133 If the @code{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1134 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1135 file. If you answer "yes", the unsaved changes to the master will be
1136 incorporated into the slave. If you answer "no", the slave may see some
1137 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1139 @node Fetching a Group
1140 @section Fetching a Group
1141 @cindex fetching a group
1143 @findex gnus-fetch-group
1144 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
1145 group and I don't care whether gnus has been started or not''. This is
1146 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
1147 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
1148 It takes the group name as a parameter.
1154 @cindex subscription
1156 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1157 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1158 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1159 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1160 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1161 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1162 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1163 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1164 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1167 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1168 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1169 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1173 @node Checking New Groups
1174 @subsection Checking New Groups
1176 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1177 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1178 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1179 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, gnus will ask the
1180 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1181 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1182 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1183 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1184 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1185 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1187 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1188 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1189 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1190 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1191 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1192 work. I could write a function to make gnus guess whether the server
1193 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1194 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1195 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1196 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1197 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1199 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, gnus will
1200 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1201 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1202 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1203 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1204 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1207 @node Subscription Methods
1208 @subsection Subscription Methods
1210 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1211 What gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1212 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1214 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1215 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1217 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1221 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1222 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1223 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1224 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1225 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1227 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1228 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1229 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1230 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1232 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1233 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1234 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1236 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1237 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1238 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1239 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1240 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1241 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1242 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1243 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1244 up. Or something like that.
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1248 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that gnus will ask
1249 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1250 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1252 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1253 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1254 Kill all new groups.
1256 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1257 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1258 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1259 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1260 topic parameter that looks like
1266 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1269 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1274 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1275 A closely related variable is
1276 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1277 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, gnus will ask you in a
1278 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1279 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1282 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1283 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1284 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1285 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1288 @node Filtering New Groups
1289 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1291 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1292 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1293 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1296 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1299 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1300 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1301 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1302 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1303 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1304 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1305 subscribing these groups.
1306 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1307 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1309 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1310 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1311 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1312 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1313 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1314 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1315 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1316 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1318 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1319 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1320 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1321 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous, but I
1322 thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is more
1323 meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is used
1324 more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new groups
1325 that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1326 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1327 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1330 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1331 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1334 @node Changing Servers
1335 @section Changing Servers
1336 @cindex changing servers
1338 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @sc{nntp} server to another.
1339 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1340 very flaky and you want to use another.
1342 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1343 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1347 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1348 @sc{nntp} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1349 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1350 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1353 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1354 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1355 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1356 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1358 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1359 @findex gnus-change-server
1360 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1361 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1362 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1363 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1364 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1366 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1367 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1368 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1369 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1370 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1373 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1374 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1375 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1376 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1377 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1379 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1380 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1381 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1382 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1384 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1385 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1386 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1387 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1388 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1389 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1390 cache for all groups).
1394 @section Startup Files
1395 @cindex startup files
1400 Now, you all know about the @file{.newsrc} file. All subscription
1401 information is traditionally stored in this file.
1403 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1404 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1405 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1406 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1407 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1408 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1409 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1411 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1412 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1413 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1414 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1415 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1416 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1418 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1419 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1420 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1421 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1422 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from gnus faster.
1423 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1424 gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1425 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes gnus ignore the
1426 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which is
1427 convenient if you have a tendency to use Netscape once in a while.
1429 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1430 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1431 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1432 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1433 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1434 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1435 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1436 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1437 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1438 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1439 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1440 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1442 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1443 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1444 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1445 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1447 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1448 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1449 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1450 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1451 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1452 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1453 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1454 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1455 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1456 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1459 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1460 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1462 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1463 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1466 @vindex gnus-init-file
1467 When gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1468 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1469 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1470 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1471 @file{site-init} files with gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1472 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1473 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1474 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1475 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
1481 @cindex dribble file
1484 Whenever you do something that changes the gnus data (reading articles,
1485 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1486 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1487 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1488 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1491 If gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1492 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1495 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1496 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, gnus won't create and
1497 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1499 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1500 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1501 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, gnus will dribble
1502 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1503 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1504 file permissions as the @code{.newsrc} file.
1506 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1507 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1508 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1511 @node The Active File
1512 @section The Active File
1514 @cindex ignored groups
1516 When gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1517 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1518 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1520 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1521 Before examining the active file, gnus deletes all lines that match the
1522 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1523 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make gnus
1524 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1525 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1526 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1529 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1530 @c if you set it to anything else.
1532 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1534 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1535 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent gnus from
1536 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1538 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1539 you actually subscribe to.
1541 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1542 variable to @code{nil} will probably make gnus slower, not faster. At
1543 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow gnus down
1544 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1546 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1547 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1548 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1549 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1550 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1551 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1553 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1554 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1555 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1558 If this variable is @code{nil}, gnus will ask for group info in total
1559 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1560 @sc{nntp} server, gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1561 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1562 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1563 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1565 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1566 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1568 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1569 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1571 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1572 secondary select methods.
1575 @node Startup Variables
1576 @section Startup Variables
1580 @item gnus-load-hook
1581 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1582 A hook run while gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1583 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1584 times you start gnus.
1586 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1587 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1588 A hook run after starting up gnus successfully.
1590 @item gnus-startup-hook
1591 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1592 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up gnus
1594 @item gnus-started-hook
1595 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1596 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up gnus
1599 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1600 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1601 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1602 generating the group buffer.
1604 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1605 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1606 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1607 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1608 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1609 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1610 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1611 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1613 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1614 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1615 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1616 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1617 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1618 @file{.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @code{.emacs} instead.
1620 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1621 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1622 Message displayed by gnus when no groups are available.
1624 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1625 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1626 If non-@code{nil}, play the gnus jingle at startup.
1628 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1629 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1630 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1631 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1637 @chapter Group Buffer
1638 @cindex group buffer
1640 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1642 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1643 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1644 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1645 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1646 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1647 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1648 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1649 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1650 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1651 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1652 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1653 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1654 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1655 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1656 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1657 @c human rights at 9...
1660 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1661 is the first buffer shown when gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1662 long as gnus is active.
1666 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1667 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1668 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1669 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1670 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1671 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1672 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1673 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1679 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1680 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1681 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1682 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1683 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1684 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1685 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1686 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1687 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1688 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1689 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1690 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1691 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1692 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1693 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1694 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1695 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1699 @node Group Buffer Format
1700 @section Group Buffer Format
1703 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1704 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
1705 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1709 @node Group Line Specification
1710 @subsection Group Line Specification
1711 @cindex group buffer format
1713 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1714 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1716 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1719 25: news.announce.newusers
1720 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1725 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1726 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1727 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1728 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1730 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1731 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1732 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1733 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1734 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1735 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1737 @samp{%M%S%5y: %(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1739 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1740 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1741 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1742 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1743 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1745 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1746 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1747 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1749 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1754 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1757 Whether the group is subscribed.
1760 Level of subscribedness.
1763 Number of unread articles.
1766 Number of dormant articles.
1769 Number of ticked articles.
1772 Number of read articles.
1775 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1776 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1778 Gnus uses this estimation because the @sc{nntp} protocol provides
1779 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1780 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1781 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1782 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1783 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1784 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1785 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1788 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1791 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1800 Newsgroup description.
1803 @samp{m} if moderated.
1806 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1815 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1819 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1822 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1823 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1824 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1825 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1826 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1829 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1831 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1835 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1838 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1842 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1843 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1844 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1845 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1846 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1847 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1852 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1853 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1854 group, or a bogus native group.
1857 @node Group Modeline Specification
1858 @subsection Group Modeline Specification
1859 @cindex group modeline
1861 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1862 The mode line can be changed by setting
1863 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1864 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1868 The native news server.
1870 The native select method.
1874 @node Group Highlighting
1875 @subsection Group Highlighting
1876 @cindex highlighting
1877 @cindex group highlighting
1879 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1880 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1881 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1882 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1883 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1885 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1889 (cond (window-system
1890 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1891 (defface my-group-face-1
1892 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1893 (defface my-group-face-2
1894 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t))) "Second group face")
1895 (defface my-group-face-3
1896 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1897 (defface my-group-face-4
1898 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1899 (defface my-group-face-5
1900 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1902 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1903 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1904 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1905 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1906 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1907 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1910 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1912 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1919 The number of unread articles in the group.
1923 Whether the group is a mail group.
1925 The level of the group.
1927 The score of the group.
1929 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1931 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather, MAX-NUMBER minus
1932 MIN-NUMBER plus one.
1934 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1935 topic being inserted.
1938 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1939 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal gnus
1940 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1942 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1943 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1944 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1945 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1946 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1949 @node Group Maneuvering
1950 @section Group Maneuvering
1951 @cindex group movement
1953 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1954 expected, hopefully.
1960 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1961 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1962 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1968 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1969 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1970 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1974 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1975 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1979 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1980 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1984 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
1985 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
1986 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
1990 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
1991 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
1992 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
1995 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2001 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2002 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2003 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2008 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2009 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2010 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2014 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2015 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2016 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2019 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2020 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2021 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2022 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2026 @node Selecting a Group
2027 @section Selecting a Group
2028 @cindex group selection
2033 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2034 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2035 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2036 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2037 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2038 this command, gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2039 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{N}, @var{N}
2040 determines the number of articles gnus will fetch. If @var{N} is
2041 positive, gnus fetches the @var{N} newest articles, if @var{N} is
2042 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{N})} oldest articles.
2044 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2045 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2046 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2048 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2049 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2054 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2055 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2056 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2057 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2058 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2062 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2063 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2064 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2065 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2066 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2067 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2068 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2069 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2070 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2071 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2074 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2075 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2076 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2077 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2078 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2081 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2082 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2083 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2084 doing any processing of its contents
2085 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2086 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2087 manner will have no permanent effects.
2091 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2092 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what gnus should consider
2093 to be a big group. This is 200 by default. If the group has more
2094 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, gnus will query the user
2095 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many articles
2096 should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a negative
2097 number (@code{-n}), the @code{n} oldest articles will be fetched. If it
2098 is positive, the @code{n} articles that have arrived most recently will
2101 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2102 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2103 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2104 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2105 Which article this is is controlled by the
2106 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2112 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2115 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2118 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2120 @item unseen-or-unread
2121 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2122 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2126 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2130 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2131 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2133 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2134 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2135 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2136 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2140 @node Subscription Commands
2141 @section Subscription Commands
2142 @cindex subscription
2150 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2151 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2152 Toggle subscription to the current group
2153 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2159 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2160 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2161 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2162 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2168 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2169 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2170 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2176 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2177 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2180 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2181 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2182 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2183 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2184 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2190 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2191 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2195 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2196 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2199 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2200 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2201 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2202 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2203 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2204 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2205 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2206 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2207 @file{.newsrc} file.
2211 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2221 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2222 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2223 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2224 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2225 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2226 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2231 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2232 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2233 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2237 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2238 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2239 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2241 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2242 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2243 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2244 If you have switched from one @sc{nntp} server to another, all your marks
2245 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2246 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2253 @section Group Levels
2257 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2258 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2259 can ask gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2260 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2261 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2263 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2269 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2270 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2271 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2272 prompted for a level.
2275 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2276 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2277 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2278 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2279 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2280 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2281 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2282 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2283 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2284 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2285 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2286 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2287 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2288 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2289 reasons of efficiency.
2291 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2292 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2294 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2295 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2296 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2297 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2298 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2299 groups are hidden, in a way.
2301 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2302 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2303 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2304 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2305 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2306 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2308 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2309 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2310 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2311 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2312 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2313 list of killed groups.)
2315 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2316 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2317 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2319 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2320 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2321 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2322 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2323 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2324 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2325 relevant valid ranges.
2327 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2328 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2329 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2330 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2331 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2332 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2335 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2336 one with the best level.
2338 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2339 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2340 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2343 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2344 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2345 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2346 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2349 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2350 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2351 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2352 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2354 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2355 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2356 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2357 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2358 to 5. The default is 6.
2362 @section Group Score
2367 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2368 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2369 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2372 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2373 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2374 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2375 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2376 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2377 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2378 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2379 least significant part.))
2381 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2382 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2383 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2384 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2385 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2386 action after each summary exit, you can add
2387 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2388 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2389 slow things down somewhat.
2392 @node Marking Groups
2393 @section Marking Groups
2394 @cindex marking groups
2396 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2397 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2398 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2399 bidding on those groups.
2401 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2402 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2403 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2411 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2412 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2418 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2419 Remove the mark from the current group
2420 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2424 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2425 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2429 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2430 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2434 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2435 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2439 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2440 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2441 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2444 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2446 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2447 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2448 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2449 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2450 the command to be executed.
2453 @node Foreign Groups
2454 @section Foreign Groups
2455 @cindex foreign groups
2457 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2458 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2459 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2460 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2467 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2468 @cindex making groups
2469 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2470 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2471 to subscribe to @sc{nntp} groups, @pxref{Browse Foreign Server}.
2475 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2476 @cindex renaming groups
2477 Rename the current group to something else
2478 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2479 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2485 @findex gnus-group-customize
2486 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2490 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2491 @cindex renaming groups
2492 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2493 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2497 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2498 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2499 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2503 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2504 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2505 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2509 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2511 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2512 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2517 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2518 Make the gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2522 @cindex (ding) archive
2523 @cindex archive group
2524 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2525 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2526 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2527 Make a gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2528 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2529 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2530 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2534 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2536 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2537 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2538 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2539 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2543 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2545 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2546 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2547 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2551 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2552 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2554 Make a group based on some file or other
2555 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2556 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2557 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2558 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2559 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2560 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2561 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2562 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2563 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2567 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2568 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2569 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2570 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2574 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2579 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2580 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2581 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2582 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2583 include @code{dejanews}, @code{altavista} and @code{reference}.
2584 @xref{Web Searches}.
2586 If you use the @code{dejanews} search engine, you can limit the search
2587 to a particular group by using a match string like
2588 @samp{~g alt.sysadmin.recovery shaving}.
2591 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2592 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2593 This function will delete the current group
2594 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2595 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2596 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2597 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2598 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} group), though.
2602 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2603 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2604 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2608 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2609 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2610 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2613 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2616 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2617 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2618 gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2619 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2620 groups from different @sc{nntp} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2621 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2625 @node Group Parameters
2626 @section Group Parameters
2627 @cindex group parameters
2629 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2630 Here's an example group parameter list:
2633 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2637 We see that each element consists of a "dotted pair"---the thing before
2638 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2639 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2640 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2642 Some parameters have correspondant customizable variables, each of which
2643 is an alist of regexps and values.
2645 The following group parameters can be used:
2650 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2653 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2656 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2657 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2658 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2659 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2660 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2662 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2663 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2664 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2665 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2666 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2667 list address instead.
2669 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2673 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2676 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2679 It is totally ignored
2680 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2681 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2683 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2684 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2685 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2686 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2687 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2689 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you don't have a
2690 @code{to-list} group parameter, one will be added automatically upon
2691 sending the message.
2693 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2694 @cindex Mail List Groups
2695 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2696 entering summary buffer.
2698 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2703 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2704 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2705 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2706 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2707 headers for your posts to these lists. Look here @pxref{(message)Mailing
2708 Lists} for a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2710 See also @code{gnus-find-subscribed-addresses}, the function that
2711 directly uses this group parameter.
2715 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2716 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2717 of whether it has any unread articles.
2719 @item broken-reply-to
2720 @cindex broken-reply-to
2721 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2722 headers in this group are to be ignored. This can be useful if you're
2723 reading a mailing list group where the listserv has inserted
2724 @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv itself. This is
2725 broken behavior. So there!
2729 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2730 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2734 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, gnus
2735 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2736 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2741 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2742 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2743 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2744 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2745 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2746 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2747 (@pxref{Archived Messages}). CAVEAT:: It yields an error putting
2748 @code{(gcc-self . t)} in groups of a @code{nntp} server or so, because
2749 a @code{nntp} server doesn't accept artciles.
2753 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2754 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2755 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2757 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2760 @cindex total-expire
2761 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2762 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2763 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2764 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2767 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2771 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2772 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(expiry-wait
2773 . 10)}, this value will override any @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and
2774 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} when expiring expirable messages.
2775 The value can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or
2776 the symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2779 @cindex score file group parameter
2780 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2781 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2782 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2785 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2786 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2787 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2788 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2791 @cindex admin-address
2792 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2793 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2794 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2795 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2799 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2800 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2804 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2807 Display the last INTEGER articles in the group. This is the same as
2808 entering the group with C-u INTEGER.
2811 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2815 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2817 Here are some examples:
2821 Display only unread articles.
2824 Display everything except expirable articles.
2826 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2827 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2831 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2832 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2833 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2834 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2835 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2839 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2840 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2841 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2845 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")}
2846 are arbitrary comments on the group. They are currently ignored by
2847 gnus, but provide a place for you to store information on particular
2852 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2853 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2854 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2856 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2858 @item ignored-charsets
2859 @cindex ignored-charset
2860 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2861 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2862 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2864 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2867 @cindex posting-style
2868 You can store additional posting style information for this group only
2869 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2870 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2871 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2872 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2874 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2875 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2876 like this in the group parameters:
2881 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2886 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2887 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2891 An item like @code{(banner . "regex")} causes any part of an article
2892 that matches the regular expression "regex" to be stripped. Instead of
2893 "regex", you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2894 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2895 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2899 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2900 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2901 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2902 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2904 For example, if the INBOX.list.sieve group has the @code{(sieve
2905 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2906 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2907 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2910 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2911 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2915 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, , Top, sieve,
2918 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2919 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2920 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2921 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2922 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2923 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2924 @code{eval}ed there.
2926 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
2927 A use for this feature, is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
2928 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
2929 @samp{nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps} has the tag
2930 @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this tag can be
2931 removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for the group by
2932 putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")} into the group
2933 parameters for the group.
2936 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function, if you'd like.
2937 If you want to hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put
2938 something like @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that
2939 group. @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the result of the
2940 @code{(ding)} form, but who cares?
2944 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2945 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2946 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2947 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2948 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2950 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
2951 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect. For
2955 (setq gnus-parameters
2957 (gnus-show-threads nil)
2958 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
2959 (gnus-summary-line-format
2960 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
2964 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
2968 (gnus-use-scoring t))
2972 (broken-reply-to . t))))
2975 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
2976 the @code{to-group} example shows.
2979 @node Listing Groups
2980 @section Listing Groups
2981 @cindex group listing
2983 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
2991 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
2992 List all groups that have unread articles
2993 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
2994 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
2995 only lists groups of level five (i. e.,
2996 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3003 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3004 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3005 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3006 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3007 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3008 unsubscribed groups).
3012 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3013 List all unread groups on a specific level
3014 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3015 with no unread articles.
3019 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3020 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3021 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3022 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3027 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3028 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3032 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3033 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3034 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3038 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3039 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3043 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3044 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3045 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3046 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3047 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3048 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3049 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3050 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3054 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3055 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3056 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3060 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3061 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3062 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3066 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3067 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3071 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3072 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3076 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3077 List groups limited within the current selection
3078 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3082 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3083 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3087 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3088 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3092 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3093 @cindex visible group parameter
3094 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3095 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3096 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3097 get the same effect.
3099 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3100 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3101 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3102 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3103 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3106 @node Sorting Groups
3107 @section Sorting Groups
3108 @cindex sorting groups
3110 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3111 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3112 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3113 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3114 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3115 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3120 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3121 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3122 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3124 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3125 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3126 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3128 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3129 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3130 Sort by group level.
3132 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3133 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3134 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3136 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3137 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3138 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3139 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3141 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3142 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3143 Sort by number of unread articles.
3145 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3146 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3147 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3149 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3150 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3151 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3156 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3157 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3161 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3162 some sorting criteria:
3166 @kindex G S a (Group)
3167 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3168 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3169 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3172 @kindex G S u (Group)
3173 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3174 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3175 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3178 @kindex G S l (Group)
3179 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3180 Sort the group buffer by group level
3181 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3184 @kindex G S v (Group)
3185 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3186 Sort the group buffer by group score
3187 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3190 @kindex G S r (Group)
3191 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3192 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3193 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3196 @kindex G S m (Group)
3197 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3198 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name
3199 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3203 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3204 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3206 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3207 commands will sort in reverse order.
3209 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3213 @kindex G P a (Group)
3214 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3215 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3216 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3219 @kindex G P u (Group)
3220 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3221 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3222 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3225 @kindex G P l (Group)
3226 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3227 Sort the groups by group level
3228 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3231 @kindex G P v (Group)
3232 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3233 Sort the groups by group score
3234 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3237 @kindex G P r (Group)
3238 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3239 Sort the groups by group rank
3240 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3243 @kindex G P m (Group)
3244 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3245 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name
3246 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3249 @kindex G P s (Group)
3250 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3251 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3255 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3259 @node Group Maintenance
3260 @section Group Maintenance
3261 @cindex bogus groups
3266 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3267 Find bogus groups and delete them
3268 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3272 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3273 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3274 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3275 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3276 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3280 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3281 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3282 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3283 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3284 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3285 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3288 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3289 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3290 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3291 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3296 @node Browse Foreign Server
3297 @section Browse Foreign Server
3298 @cindex foreign servers
3299 @cindex browsing servers
3304 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3305 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3306 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3307 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3310 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3311 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3312 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3313 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3315 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3320 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3321 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3325 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3326 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3329 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3330 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3331 Enter the current group and display the first article
3332 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3335 @kindex RET (Browse)
3336 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3337 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3341 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3342 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3343 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3349 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3350 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3354 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3355 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3356 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3361 @section Exiting gnus
3362 @cindex exiting gnus
3364 Yes, gnus is ex(c)iting.
3369 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3370 Suspend gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit gnus,
3371 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3372 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3376 @findex gnus-group-exit
3377 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3378 Quit gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3382 @findex gnus-group-quit
3383 Quit gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3384 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3387 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3388 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3389 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend gnus and
3390 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit gnus, while
3391 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3396 If you wish to completely unload gnus and all its adherents, you can use
3397 the @code{gnus-unload} command. This command is also very handy when
3398 trying to customize meta-variables.
3403 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3404 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3405 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3411 @section Group Topics
3414 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3415 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3416 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3417 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3418 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3419 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3423 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3424 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3435 2: alt.religion.emacs
3438 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3440 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3441 13: comp.sources.unix
3444 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3446 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3447 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3448 is a toggling command.)
3450 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3451 dum... Nice tune, that... la la la... What, you're back? Yes, and
3452 now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed under
3453 @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy? Hot and
3456 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3457 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3458 @file{~/.gnus} file:
3461 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3465 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3466 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3467 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3468 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3469 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3473 @node Topic Commands
3474 @subsection Topic Commands
3475 @cindex topic commands
3477 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3478 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3479 definitions slightly.
3481 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3482 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3483 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3484 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3485 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3486 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3488 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3495 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3496 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3497 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3501 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3503 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3504 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3505 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3506 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3509 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3510 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3511 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3512 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3516 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3517 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3518 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3519 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3525 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3526 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3527 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3531 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3532 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3533 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3536 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3537 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the `cut' part of cut and paste. Then,
3538 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the `Gnus'
3539 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the `paste' part of cut and
3540 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3542 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3543 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3547 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3548 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3555 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3557 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3558 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3559 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3560 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3561 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3562 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3566 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3572 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3573 Move the current group to some other topic
3574 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3575 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3579 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3580 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3584 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3585 Copy the current group to some other topic
3586 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3587 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3591 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3592 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3593 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3597 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3598 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3599 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3603 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3604 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3605 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3606 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3607 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3608 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3609 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3612 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3613 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3617 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3618 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3619 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3623 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3624 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3625 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3629 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3630 Toggle hiding empty topics
3631 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3635 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3636 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3637 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}).
3640 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3641 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3642 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3643 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}).
3646 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3647 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3648 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3649 expiry process (if any)
3650 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3654 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3655 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3658 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3659 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3660 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3664 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3665 List all groups that gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3666 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3669 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3670 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3671 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3674 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3675 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3676 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3680 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3681 @cindex group parameters
3682 @cindex topic parameters
3684 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3685 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3690 @node Topic Variables
3691 @subsection Topic Variables
3692 @cindex topic variables
3694 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3695 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3697 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3698 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3699 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3712 Number of groups in the topic.
3714 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3716 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3719 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3720 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3721 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3724 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3725 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3727 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3728 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3729 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3733 @subsection Topic Sorting
3734 @cindex topic sorting
3736 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3742 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3743 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3744 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3745 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3748 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3749 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3750 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3751 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3754 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3755 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3756 Sort the current topic by group level
3757 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3760 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3761 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3762 Sort the current topic by group score
3763 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3766 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3767 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3768 Sort the current topic by group rank
3769 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3772 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3773 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3774 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3775 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3778 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3779 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3780 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3781 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3785 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3786 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3787 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3788 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3792 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3793 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3797 @node Topic Topology
3798 @subsection Topic Topology
3799 @cindex topic topology
3802 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3808 2: alt.religion.emacs
3811 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3813 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3814 13: comp.sources.unix
3817 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3818 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3819 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3824 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3825 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3829 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3830 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3831 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3832 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3833 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3834 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3836 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3837 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3838 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3841 @node Topic Parameters
3842 @subsection Topic Parameters
3843 @cindex topic parameters
3845 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent (and
3846 ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid topic
3847 parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
3849 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3854 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3855 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3856 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3859 @item subscribe-level
3860 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3861 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3862 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3866 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3867 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3868 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3869 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3875 2: alt.religion.emacs
3879 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3881 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3882 13: comp.sources.unix
3886 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3887 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3888 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3889 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
3890 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
3891 . "religion.SCORE")}.
3893 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
3894 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
3895 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
3896 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
3897 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
3899 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
3900 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
3901 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
3902 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
3903 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
3904 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
3905 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
3906 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
3909 @node Misc Group Stuff
3910 @section Misc Group Stuff
3913 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
3914 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
3915 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
3916 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
3917 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
3924 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
3925 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
3926 @xref{Server Buffer}.
3930 @findex gnus-group-post-news
3931 Start composing a message (a news by default)
3932 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
3933 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
3934 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
3935 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
3936 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
3940 @findex gnus-group-mail
3941 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
3942 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
3943 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
3944 @xref{Composing Messages}.
3948 @findex gnus-group-news
3949 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
3950 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
3951 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
3953 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
3954 This is useful for "posting" messages to mail groups without actually
3955 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
3956 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
3957 for this to work though.
3961 Variables for the group buffer:
3965 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
3966 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
3967 is called after the group buffer has been
3970 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
3971 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3972 is called after the group buffer is
3973 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
3976 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
3977 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3978 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
3979 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
3981 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3982 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3983 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
3984 whether they are empty or not.
3986 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3987 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3988 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
3989 non-ASCII group names.
3993 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3994 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
3997 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3998 @cindex UTF-8 group names
3999 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4000 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4001 is used to show non-ASCII group names. @code{((".*" utf-8))} is the
4002 default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the default is nil.
4006 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4007 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4012 @node Scanning New Messages
4013 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4014 @cindex new messages
4015 @cindex scanning new news
4021 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4022 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4023 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4024 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4025 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4026 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4031 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4032 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4033 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4034 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4035 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4036 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4037 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4039 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4040 @cindex activating groups
4042 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4043 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4048 @findex gnus-group-restart
4049 Restart gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4050 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4051 gnus variables, and then starts gnus all over again.
4055 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4056 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4058 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4059 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4063 @node Group Information
4064 @subsection Group Information
4065 @cindex group information
4066 @cindex information on groups
4073 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4074 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4077 Try to fetch the FAQ for the current group
4078 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the FAQ from
4079 @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on a
4080 remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories. In
4081 that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4082 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be used
4083 for fetching the file.
4085 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, gnus will attempt to go
4086 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4090 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4092 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4093 @cindex describing groups
4094 @cindex group description
4095 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4096 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4097 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4101 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4102 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4103 prefix, force gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4110 @findex gnus-version
4111 Display current gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4115 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4116 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4119 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4122 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4123 Go to the gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4127 @node Group Timestamp
4128 @subsection Group Timestamp
4130 @cindex group timestamps
4132 It can be convenient to let gnus keep track of when you last read a
4133 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4134 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4137 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4140 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4142 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4143 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4146 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4147 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4150 This will result in lines looking like:
4153 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4154 0: custom 19961002T012713
4157 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4158 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4162 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4163 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4166 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4167 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4171 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4172 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4173 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4174 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4176 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4182 @subsection File Commands
4183 @cindex file commands
4189 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4190 @vindex gnus-init-file
4191 @cindex reading init file
4192 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4193 @file{~/.gnus}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4197 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4198 @cindex saving .newsrc
4199 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4200 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4201 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4204 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4205 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4206 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4211 @node Sieve Commands
4212 @subsection Sieve Commands
4213 @cindex group sieve commands
4215 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4216 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4217 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4218 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4219 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4221 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4222 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4223 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4224 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4225 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4226 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4227 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4228 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4229 regenerate the Sieve script.
4231 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4232 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4233 is generated. If it is non-nil (the default) articles is placed in
4234 all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article is only
4235 placed in the group with the first matching rule. For example, the
4236 group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4237 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4238 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is nil. (When
4239 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-nil, it looks the same except that
4240 the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4243 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4244 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4249 @xref{Top, ,Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4255 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4256 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4257 @cindex generating sieve script
4258 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4259 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4263 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4264 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4265 @cindex updating sieve script
4266 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4267 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4268 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4273 @node Summary Buffer
4274 @chapter Summary Buffer
4275 @cindex summary buffer
4277 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4278 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4280 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4281 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4283 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4286 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4287 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4288 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4289 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4290 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4291 * Delayed Articles::
4292 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4293 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4294 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4295 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4296 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4297 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4298 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4299 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4300 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4301 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4302 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4303 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4304 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4305 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4306 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4307 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4308 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4309 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4310 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4311 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4312 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4313 or reselecting the current group.
4314 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4315 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4316 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4317 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4321 @node Summary Buffer Format
4322 @section Summary Buffer Format
4323 @cindex summary buffer format
4327 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4328 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4329 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4335 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4336 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4337 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4338 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4341 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4342 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4343 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4344 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4345 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4346 @code{From} header. Three pre-defined functions exist:
4347 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4348 fast, and too simplistic solution;
4349 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works nicely, but is
4350 slower; and @code{std11-extract-address-components}, which works very
4351 nicely, but is slower. The default function will return the wrong
4352 answer in 5% of the cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the
4353 other function instead:
4356 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4357 'mail-extract-address-components)
4360 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4361 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4362 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4363 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4366 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4367 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4369 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4370 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4371 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4372 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4373 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4375 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4376 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4377 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4378 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4379 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4380 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4382 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4384 The following format specification characters and extended format
4385 specification(s) are understood:
4391 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4392 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4394 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4395 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4396 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4398 Full @code{From} header.
4400 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4402 The name, code @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header
4403 (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
4405 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4406 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4407 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4408 may be more thorough.
4410 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4413 Number of lines in the article.
4415 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4416 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4418 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4420 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4423 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4424 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4426 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4427 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4429 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4430 for adopted articles.
4432 One space for each thread level.
4434 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4436 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4439 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4440 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4441 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4444 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4446 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4447 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4448 default level. If the difference between
4449 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4450 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4458 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4460 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4466 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4467 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4469 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4470 article has any children.
4476 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4477 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4479 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4480 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4481 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
4482 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4483 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4484 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4487 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4488 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4489 There can only be one such area.
4491 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4492 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, gnus will
4493 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4494 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4495 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4496 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4498 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4499 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4501 This restriction may disappear in later versions of gnus.
4504 @node To From Newsgroups
4505 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4509 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4510 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4511 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4512 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4513 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4517 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4518 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4519 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4523 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4524 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4527 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4528 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4531 @findex gnus-extra-header
4532 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4533 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4534 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4537 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4541 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4542 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4543 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4544 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4545 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4546 headers are used instead.
4550 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4551 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4552 to include extra headers when generating overview (@sc{nov}) files. If
4553 you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after changing
4556 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4557 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4558 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4559 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4561 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4565 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4567 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4568 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4569 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4570 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4574 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4577 Now, this is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4578 the @sc{nov} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4585 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4586 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4589 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4590 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4592 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4593 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4594 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4595 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4597 Here are the elements you can play with:
4603 Unprefixed group name.
4605 Current article number.
4607 Current article score.
4611 Number of unread articles in this group.
4613 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4616 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4617 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4618 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4619 and no unselected ones.
4621 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4622 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4624 Subject of the current article.
4626 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4628 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4630 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4632 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4634 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4636 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4640 @node Summary Highlighting
4641 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4645 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4646 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4647 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4648 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4649 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4651 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4652 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4653 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4654 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4656 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4657 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4658 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4659 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4661 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4662 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4663 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4664 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4665 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4666 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4669 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4670 ((> score default) . bold))
4672 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4673 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4677 @node Summary Maneuvering
4678 @section Summary Maneuvering
4679 @cindex summary movement
4681 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4682 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4684 None of these commands select articles.
4689 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4690 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4691 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4692 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4693 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4697 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4698 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4699 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4700 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4701 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4704 @kindex G g (Summary)
4705 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4706 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4707 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4710 If gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4711 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4712 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4713 to the group buffer.
4715 Variables related to summary movement:
4719 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4720 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4721 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4722 no more unread articles after the current one, gnus will offer to go to
4723 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4724 empty, gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4725 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, gnus will select the
4726 next group, no matter whether it has any unread articles or not. As a
4727 special case, if this variable is @code{quietly}, gnus will select the
4728 next group without asking for confirmation. If this variable is
4729 @code{almost-quietly}, the same will happen only if you are located on
4730 the last article in the group. Finally, if this variable is
4731 @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n} command will go to the next group
4732 without confirmation. Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
4734 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4735 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4736 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4737 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4738 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4739 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4740 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4742 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4744 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4745 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4746 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4747 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4748 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4750 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4751 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4752 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4753 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4754 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4755 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4756 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4757 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4760 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4761 the given number of lines from the top.
4766 @node Choosing Articles
4767 @section Choosing Articles
4768 @cindex selecting articles
4771 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4772 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4776 @node Choosing Commands
4777 @subsection Choosing Commands
4779 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4780 and they all select and display an article.
4782 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4783 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4787 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4788 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4789 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4790 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4795 @kindex G n (Summary)
4796 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
4797 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
4798 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4803 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
4804 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
4805 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
4810 @kindex G N (Summary)
4811 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
4812 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
4817 @kindex G P (Summary)
4818 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
4819 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
4822 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
4823 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
4824 Go to the next article with the same subject
4825 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
4828 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
4829 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
4830 Go to the previous article with the same subject
4831 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
4835 @kindex G f (Summary)
4837 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
4838 Go to the first unread article
4839 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
4843 @kindex G b (Summary)
4845 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
4846 Go to the unread article with the highest score
4847 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
4848 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
4853 @kindex G l (Summary)
4854 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
4855 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
4858 @kindex G o (Summary)
4859 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
4861 @cindex article history
4862 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
4863 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
4864 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
4865 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
4866 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
4867 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
4872 @kindex G j (Summary)
4873 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
4874 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
4875 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
4880 @node Choosing Variables
4881 @subsection Choosing Variables
4883 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
4886 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4887 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4888 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
4889 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
4890 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
4891 the server and display it in the article buffer.
4893 @item gnus-select-article-hook
4894 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
4895 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
4896 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article.
4898 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
4899 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
4900 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
4901 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
4902 @findex gnus-unread-mark
4903 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
4904 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
4905 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
4906 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
4907 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
4908 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
4909 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
4910 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
4911 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
4916 @node Paging the Article
4917 @section Scrolling the Article
4918 @cindex article scrolling
4923 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
4924 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4925 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
4926 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
4927 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4930 @kindex DEL (Summary)
4931 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
4932 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
4935 @kindex RET (Summary)
4936 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
4937 Scroll the current article one line forward
4938 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
4941 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
4942 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
4943 Scroll the current article one line backward
4944 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
4948 @kindex A g (Summary)
4950 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
4951 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4952 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
4953 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
4954 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
4955 the way it came from the server.
4957 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
4958 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
4959 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
4962 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4967 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
4972 @kindex A < (Summary)
4973 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
4974 Scroll to the beginning of the article
4975 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
4980 @kindex A > (Summary)
4981 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
4982 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
4986 @kindex A s (Summary)
4988 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
4989 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
4990 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
4994 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
4995 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5000 @node Reply Followup and Post
5001 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5004 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5005 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5006 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5007 * Canceling and Superseding::
5011 @node Summary Mail Commands
5012 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5014 @cindex composing mail
5016 Commands for composing a mail message:
5022 @kindex S r (Summary)
5024 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5025 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5026 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5027 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5028 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5033 @kindex S R (Summary)
5034 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5035 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5036 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5037 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5038 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5041 @kindex S w (Summary)
5042 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5043 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5044 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5045 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5046 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers.
5049 @kindex S W (Summary)
5050 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5051 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5052 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5053 the process/prefix convention.
5056 @kindex S v (Summary)
5057 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5058 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5059 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5060 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5061 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5062 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5066 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5067 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5068 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5069 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5070 Forward the current article to some other person
5071 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If given a prefix, include the full
5072 headers of the forwarded article.
5077 @kindex S m (Summary)
5078 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5079 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5080 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5081 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5082 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5087 @kindex S i (Summary)
5088 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5089 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5090 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5091 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5093 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5094 This is useful for "posting" messages to mail groups without actually
5095 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5096 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5097 for this to work though.
5100 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5101 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5102 @cindex bouncing mail
5103 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5104 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5105 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5106 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5107 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5108 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, gnus will try to fetch
5109 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5110 very well fail, though.
5113 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5114 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5115 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5116 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5117 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5118 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5119 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5120 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5121 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5122 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5124 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5125 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5126 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5127 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5128 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5130 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5131 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5134 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5135 @findex gnus-summary-digest-mail-forward
5136 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5137 result using mail (@code{gnus-summary-digest-mail-forward}). This
5138 command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5141 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5142 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5143 @cindex crossposting
5144 @cindex excessive crossposting
5145 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5146 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5148 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5149 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5150 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5151 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5152 command understands the process/prefix convention
5153 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5157 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5158 Manual}, for more information.
5161 @node Summary Post Commands
5162 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5164 @cindex composing news
5166 Commands for posting a news article:
5172 @kindex S p (Summary)
5173 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5174 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5175 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5176 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5177 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5182 @kindex S f (Summary)
5183 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5184 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5185 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5189 @kindex S F (Summary)
5191 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5192 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5193 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5194 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5195 process/prefix convention.
5198 @kindex S n (Summary)
5199 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5200 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5201 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5204 @kindex S N (Summary)
5205 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5206 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5207 message through mail and include the original message
5208 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5209 the process/prefix convention.
5212 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5213 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5214 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5215 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}). If given a prefix, include the full
5216 headers of the forwarded article.
5219 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5220 @findex gnus-summary-digest-post-forward
5222 @cindex making digests
5223 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5224 (@code{gnus-summary-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5225 process/prefix convention.
5228 @kindex S u (Summary)
5229 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5230 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5231 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5232 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5235 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5236 Manual}, for more information.
5239 @node Summary Message Commands
5240 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5244 @kindex S y (Summary)
5245 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5246 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5247 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5248 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5249 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5254 @node Canceling and Superseding
5255 @subsection Canceling Articles
5256 @cindex canceling articles
5257 @cindex superseding articles
5259 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5260 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5262 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5264 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5266 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5267 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5268 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5269 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5270 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5271 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5273 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5274 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5277 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5278 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5279 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5281 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5282 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5283 your original article.
5285 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5287 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5288 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5289 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5292 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5293 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5294 have posted almost the same article twice.
5296 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5297 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5298 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5299 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5300 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5301 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5302 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5303 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5304 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5305 canceled/superseded.
5307 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5309 @node Delayed Articles
5310 @section Delayed Articles
5311 @cindex delayed sending
5312 @cindex send delayed
5314 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5315 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5316 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5317 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5320 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5323 @findex gnus-delay-article
5324 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5325 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5326 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5327 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5331 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5332 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5333 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5334 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5337 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5338 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5339 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5342 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5343 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5344 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5345 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5346 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5347 that means a time tomorrow.
5350 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5351 couple of variables:
5354 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5355 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5356 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5357 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5359 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5360 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5361 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5362 formats described above.
5364 @item gnus-delay-group
5365 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5366 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5367 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5368 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5370 @item gnus-delay-header
5371 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5372 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5373 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5374 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5377 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5378 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5379 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5380 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5381 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5383 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5384 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5385 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5386 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5387 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5388 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5391 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5392 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5393 By default, this function installs the @kbd{C-c C-j} key binding in
5394 Message mode and @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5395 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts two optional arguments,
5396 @code{no-keymap} and @code{no-check}. If @code{no-keymap} is non-nil,
5397 the @kbd{C-c C-j} binding is not intalled. If @code{no-check} is
5398 non-nil, @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed.
5400 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to change the
5401 keymap but not to change @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. Presumably, you
5402 want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles. Just don't
5403 forget to set that up :-)
5407 @node Marking Articles
5408 @section Marking Articles
5409 @cindex article marking
5410 @cindex article ticking
5413 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5415 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5416 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5417 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5419 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5422 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5423 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5424 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5428 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks:
5432 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5433 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5434 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5438 @node Unread Articles
5439 @subsection Unread Articles
5441 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5446 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5447 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5449 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5450 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5451 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5452 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5453 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5454 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5455 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5458 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5459 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5461 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5462 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5463 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5464 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5468 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5469 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5471 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5476 @subsection Read Articles
5477 @cindex expirable mark
5479 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5484 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5485 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5486 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5489 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5490 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5493 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5494 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5495 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5498 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5499 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5502 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5503 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5506 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5507 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5510 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5511 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5514 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5515 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5518 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5519 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5522 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5523 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5527 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5528 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5529 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5533 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5534 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5536 One more special mark, though:
5540 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5541 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5543 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5544 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5545 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5546 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by gnus at
5552 @subsection Other Marks
5553 @cindex process mark
5556 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5562 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5563 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5564 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5565 in the article, and gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5566 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5569 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5570 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5571 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5572 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5575 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5576 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5577 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5580 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5581 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5582 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5585 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5586 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5587 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5588 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5591 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5592 Articles that according to the back end haven't been seen by the user
5593 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5594 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all back ends support this
5595 mark, in which case it simply never appears.
5598 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5599 Articles that haven't been seen by the user before are marked with a
5600 @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5603 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5604 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5605 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5606 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5607 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5610 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5611 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5612 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5613 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5614 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5615 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5619 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5620 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5621 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5623 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5624 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5625 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5629 @subsection Setting Marks
5630 @cindex setting marks
5632 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5637 @kindex M c (Summary)
5638 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5639 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5640 @cindex mark as unread
5641 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5642 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5648 @kindex M t (Summary)
5649 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5650 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5651 @xref{Article Caching}.
5656 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5657 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5658 Mark the current article as dormant
5659 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5663 @kindex M d (Summary)
5665 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5666 Mark the current article as read
5667 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5671 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5672 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5673 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5678 @kindex M k (Summary)
5679 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5680 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5681 and then select the next unread article
5682 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5686 @kindex M K (Summary)
5687 @kindex C-k (Summary)
5688 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5689 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5690 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5693 @kindex M C (Summary)
5694 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5695 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5696 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5699 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
5700 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5701 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5702 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5705 @kindex M H (Summary)
5706 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5707 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
5708 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5711 @kindex M h (Summary)
5712 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
5713 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
5714 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
5717 @kindex C-w (Summary)
5718 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
5719 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
5720 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
5723 @kindex M V k (Summary)
5724 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
5725 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
5726 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
5730 @kindex M e (Summary)
5732 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
5733 Mark the current article as expirable
5734 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
5737 @kindex M b (Summary)
5738 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
5739 Set a bookmark in the current article
5740 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
5743 @kindex M B (Summary)
5744 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
5745 Remove the bookmark from the current article
5746 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
5749 @kindex M V c (Summary)
5750 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
5751 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
5752 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5755 @kindex M V u (Summary)
5756 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
5757 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
5758 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
5761 @kindex M V m (Summary)
5762 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
5763 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
5764 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
5765 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5768 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
5769 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
5770 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
5771 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
5772 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
5773 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
5774 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
5775 The default is @code{t}.
5778 @node Generic Marking Commands
5779 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
5781 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
5782 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
5783 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
5784 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
5785 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
5788 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
5789 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
5792 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
5793 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
5794 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
5795 to list in this manual.
5797 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
5798 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
5799 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
5800 article, you could say something like:
5803 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
5804 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5805 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
5811 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5812 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
5816 @node Setting Process Marks
5817 @subsection Setting Process Marks
5818 @cindex setting process marks
5825 @kindex M P p (Summary)
5826 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
5827 Mark the current article with the process mark
5828 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
5829 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
5833 @kindex M P u (Summary)
5834 @kindex M-# (Summary)
5835 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
5836 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
5839 @kindex M P U (Summary)
5840 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
5841 Remove the process mark from all articles
5842 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
5845 @kindex M P i (Summary)
5846 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
5847 Invert the list of process marked articles
5848 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
5851 @kindex M P R (Summary)
5852 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
5853 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5854 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
5857 @kindex M P G (Summary)
5858 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
5859 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5860 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
5863 @kindex M P r (Summary)
5864 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
5865 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
5868 @kindex M P t (Summary)
5869 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
5870 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5871 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
5874 @kindex M P T (Summary)
5875 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
5876 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5877 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
5880 @kindex M P v (Summary)
5881 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
5882 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
5883 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
5886 @kindex M P s (Summary)
5887 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
5888 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5891 @kindex M P S (Summary)
5892 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
5893 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
5894 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
5897 @kindex M P a (Summary)
5898 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
5899 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5902 @kindex M P b (Summary)
5903 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
5904 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
5905 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
5908 @kindex M P k (Summary)
5909 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
5910 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
5911 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
5914 @kindex M P y (Summary)
5915 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
5916 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
5917 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
5920 @kindex M P w (Summary)
5921 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
5922 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
5923 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
5927 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @pxref{Searching for Articles} for how to
5928 set process marks based on article body contents.
5935 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
5936 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
5937 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
5940 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
5941 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
5942 additional articles.
5948 @kindex / / (Summary)
5949 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
5950 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
5951 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
5955 @kindex / a (Summary)
5956 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
5957 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
5958 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
5962 @kindex / x (Summary)
5963 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
5964 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
5965 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
5966 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
5971 @kindex / u (Summary)
5973 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
5974 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
5975 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
5976 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
5977 dormant articles will also be excluded.
5980 @kindex / m (Summary)
5981 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
5982 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
5983 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
5986 @kindex / t (Summary)
5987 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
5988 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
5989 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
5990 articles younger than that number of days.
5993 @kindex / n (Summary)
5994 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
5995 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
5996 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
5997 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6000 @kindex / w (Summary)
6001 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6002 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6003 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6007 @kindex / v (Summary)
6008 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6009 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6010 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6013 @kindex / p (Summary)
6014 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6015 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6016 group parameter predicate
6017 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). See @pxref{Group
6018 Parameters} for more on this predicate.
6022 @kindex M S (Summary)
6023 @kindex / E (Summary)
6024 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6025 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6026 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6029 @kindex / D (Summary)
6030 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6031 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6032 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6035 @kindex / * (Summary)
6036 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6037 Include all cached articles in the limit
6038 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6041 @kindex / d (Summary)
6042 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6043 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6044 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6047 @kindex / M (Summary)
6048 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6049 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6052 @kindex / T (Summary)
6053 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6054 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6057 @kindex / c (Summary)
6058 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6059 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit
6060 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6063 @kindex / C (Summary)
6064 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6065 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6066 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6067 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6070 @kindex / N (Summary)
6071 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6072 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6073 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6076 @kindex / o (Summary)
6077 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6078 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6079 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6087 @cindex article threading
6089 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6090 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6091 hierarchical fashion.
6093 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6094 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6095 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6096 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6097 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6098 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6099 @pxref{Customizing Threading}.
6101 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6105 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6108 A tree-like article structure.
6111 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6114 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6115 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6116 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6117 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6118 called loose threads.
6120 @item thread gathering
6121 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6123 @item sparse threads
6124 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6125 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6131 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6132 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6136 @node Customizing Threading
6137 @subsection Customizing Threading
6138 @cindex customizing threading
6141 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6142 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6143 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6144 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
6149 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6152 @cindex loose threads
6155 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6156 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6157 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6158 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6159 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6160 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6162 When there is no real root of a thread, gnus will have to fudge
6163 something. This variable says what fudging method gnus should use.
6164 There are four possible values:
6168 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6169 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6170 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6171 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6172 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6177 @cindex adopting articles
6182 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6183 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6184 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6185 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6188 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6189 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6190 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6191 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6192 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6193 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6194 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6197 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6198 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6199 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6203 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6204 display them after one another.
6207 Don't gather loose threads.
6210 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6211 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6212 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6213 variable is @code{nil}, gnus requires an exact match between the
6214 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6215 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6216 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6217 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6218 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6219 variable to a really low number, you'll find that gnus will gather
6220 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6222 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6223 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, gnus will
6224 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6227 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6228 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6229 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6230 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6231 simplification is used.
6233 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6234 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6235 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6236 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6238 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6240 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6246 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6247 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6248 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6249 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6254 (mapconcat 'identity
6255 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6257 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6260 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6263 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6264 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6265 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6266 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6267 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6268 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6270 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6273 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6274 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6275 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6277 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6278 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6281 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6282 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6283 Remove excessive whitespace.
6285 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6286 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6287 Remove all whitespace.
6290 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6293 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6294 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6295 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6296 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6297 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6298 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6299 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6300 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6302 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6303 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6304 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6305 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6306 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6307 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6308 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6309 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6310 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6314 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6315 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6316 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6317 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6319 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6320 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6321 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6324 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6328 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6329 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6335 @node Filling In Threads
6336 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6339 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6340 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6341 If non-@code{nil}, gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6342 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you
6343 would like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still
6344 connect as many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable
6345 to @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than
6346 that number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case,
6347 fetching old headers only works if the back end you are using carries
6348 overview files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6349 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6350 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can do
6353 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6354 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6355 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6357 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6358 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6359 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6360 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6361 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6362 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6363 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where gnus guesses that an article
6364 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6365 lines. If you select a gap, gnus will try to fetch the article in
6366 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, gnus will display all these
6367 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6368 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, gnus won't cut
6369 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6370 @code{nil} by default.
6372 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6373 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6374 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6375 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6376 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6377 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6378 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6380 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6381 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6382 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6387 @node More Threading
6388 @subsubsection More Threading
6391 @item gnus-show-threads
6392 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6393 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6394 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6395 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6396 slower and more awkward.
6398 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6399 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6400 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6403 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6404 Avaliable predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6405 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}).
6410 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6411 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6412 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6415 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6416 unread, but you get my drift.)
6419 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6420 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6421 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6422 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6423 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6424 threads are expunged.
6426 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6427 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6428 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6431 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6432 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6433 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6434 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6435 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6436 result in a new thread.
6438 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6439 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6440 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6443 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6444 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6445 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6446 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6447 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6448 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6449 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6450 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6451 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6452 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6453 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6458 @node Low-Level Threading
6459 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6463 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6464 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6465 Hook run before parsing any headers. The default value is
6466 @code{(gnus-set-summary-default-charset)}, which sets up local value of
6467 @code{default-mime-charset} in summary buffer based on variable
6468 @code{gnus-newsgroup-default-charset-alist}.
6470 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6471 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6472 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6473 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6474 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6475 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6476 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6477 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6478 meaningful. Here's one example:
6481 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6483 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6484 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6486 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6488 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6495 @node Thread Commands
6496 @subsection Thread Commands
6497 @cindex thread commands
6503 @kindex T k (Summary)
6504 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6505 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6506 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6507 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6508 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6513 @kindex T l (Summary)
6514 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6515 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6516 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6517 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6520 @kindex T i (Summary)
6521 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6522 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6523 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6526 @kindex T # (Summary)
6527 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6528 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6529 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6532 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6533 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6534 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6535 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6538 @kindex T T (Summary)
6539 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6540 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6543 @kindex T s (Summary)
6544 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6545 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any
6546 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6549 @kindex T h (Summary)
6550 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6551 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6554 @kindex T S (Summary)
6555 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6556 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6559 @kindex T H (Summary)
6560 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6561 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6564 @kindex T t (Summary)
6565 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6566 Re-thread the current article's thread
6567 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6568 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6571 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6572 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6573 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6574 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6578 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6579 understand the numeric prefix.
6584 @kindex T n (Summary)
6586 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6588 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6589 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6590 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6593 @kindex T p (Summary)
6595 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6597 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6598 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6599 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6602 @kindex T d (Summary)
6603 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6604 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6607 @kindex T u (Summary)
6608 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6609 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6612 @kindex T o (Summary)
6613 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6614 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6617 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6618 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6619 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6620 a command like `T k' (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6621 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6622 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6623 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6624 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6625 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6626 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6627 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6628 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6632 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
6633 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
6635 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
6636 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
6637 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
6638 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6639 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
6640 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6641 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
6642 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-thread
6643 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
6644 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
6645 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
6646 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
6648 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
6649 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
6650 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
6651 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
6652 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
6653 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date} and
6654 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
6656 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
6657 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
6658 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6660 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6661 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6662 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6663 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6664 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6665 ascending article order.
6667 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6668 by number, you could do something like:
6671 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6672 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6673 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6674 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
6677 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
6678 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
6679 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
6680 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
6681 which the articles arrived.
6683 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
6687 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6689 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
6690 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
6693 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
6694 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
6695 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
6696 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
6699 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
6700 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
6701 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
6702 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
6703 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
6704 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
6705 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or other,
6706 you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions} variable.
6707 It is very similar to the @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that
6708 it uses slightly different functions for article comparison. Available
6709 sorting predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
6710 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject},
6711 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date}, and @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
6713 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
6717 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
6718 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
6719 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
6724 @node Asynchronous Fetching
6725 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
6726 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
6727 @cindex article pre-fetch
6730 If you read your news from an @sc{nntp} server that's far away, the
6731 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
6732 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
6733 article appears. Why can't gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
6734 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
6736 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
6737 article fetching, especially the way gnus does it.
6739 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
6740 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
6741 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
6742 article 3, but since gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
6743 connection is blocked.
6745 To avoid these situations, gnus will open two (count 'em two)
6746 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
6747 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
6748 extra connection takes some time, so gnus startup will be slower.
6750 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
6751 the link between your machine and the @sc{nntp} server will become more
6752 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
6753 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
6756 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing... unless
6759 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
6760 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
6761 happen automatically.
6763 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
6764 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
6765 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
6766 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
6767 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
6768 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
6769 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
6771 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
6772 @findex gnus-async-read-p
6773 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
6774 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p} variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This function should
6775 return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is to be
6776 pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which returns
6777 @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an article
6778 data structure as the only parameter.
6780 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter than 100 lines, you could say something like:
6783 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
6784 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
6785 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
6786 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
6789 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
6792 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
6793 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down gnus too much.
6794 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
6796 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
6797 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
6798 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
6799 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
6803 Remove articles when they are read.
6806 Remove articles when exiting the group.
6809 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
6811 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
6812 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
6813 @c from the next group.
6816 @node Article Caching
6817 @section Article Caching
6818 @cindex article caching
6821 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @sc{nntp} connection, you may
6822 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
6823 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
6824 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
6825 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
6827 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
6829 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
6830 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
6831 @vindex gnus-use-cache
6832 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
6833 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
6834 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
6835 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
6836 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
6838 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
6839 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
6840 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
6841 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
6842 as dormant, and don't worry.
6844 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
6846 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
6847 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
6848 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
6849 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
6850 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
6851 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
6852 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
6853 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
6854 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
6855 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
6857 @findex gnus-jog-cache
6858 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
6859 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
6860 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
6861 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
6862 command if 1) your connection to the @sc{nntp} server is really, really,
6863 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
6864 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
6865 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
6866 not then be downloaded by this command.
6868 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
6869 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
6870 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
6871 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
6872 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
6873 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
6875 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
6876 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
6877 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
6878 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
6879 variables, the group is not cached.
6881 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
6882 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
6883 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
6884 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
6885 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
6886 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, gnus
6887 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
6888 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @sc{nov}
6889 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
6892 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
6893 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
6894 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
6895 where, isn't that cool?
6897 @node Persistent Articles
6898 @section Persistent Articles
6899 @cindex persistent articles
6901 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
6902 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
6903 useful in my opinion.
6905 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
6906 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
6907 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
6908 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
6909 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
6910 the expiry going on at the news server.
6912 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
6913 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
6914 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
6920 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
6921 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
6924 @kindex M-* (Summary)
6925 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
6926 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
6927 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
6931 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
6933 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
6934 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
6935 interested in persistent articles:
6938 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
6942 @node Article Backlog
6943 @section Article Backlog
6945 @cindex article backlog
6947 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
6948 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
6949 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where gnus will buffer
6950 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
6951 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
6952 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
6953 that, turning the backlog on will slow gnus down a little bit, and
6954 increase memory usage some.
6956 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
6957 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, gnus will store
6958 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
6959 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, gnus will store
6960 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
6961 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
6962 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
6964 This variable is @code{nil} by default.
6967 @node Saving Articles
6968 @section Saving Articles
6969 @cindex saving articles
6971 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
6972 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
6973 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
6974 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
6975 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
6977 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
6978 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
6979 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
6981 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
6982 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, gnus will not delete
6983 unwanted headers before saving the article.
6985 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
6986 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
6987 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
6988 deleted before saving.
6994 @kindex O o (Summary)
6996 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
6997 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
6998 Save the current article using the default article saver
6999 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7002 @kindex O m (Summary)
7003 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7004 Save the current article in mail format
7005 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7008 @kindex O r (Summary)
7009 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7010 Save the current article in rmail format
7011 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7014 @kindex O f (Summary)
7015 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7016 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7017 Save the current article in plain file format
7018 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7021 @kindex O F (Summary)
7022 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7023 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7024 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7027 @kindex O b (Summary)
7028 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7029 Save the current article body in plain file format
7030 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7033 @kindex O h (Summary)
7034 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7035 Save the current article in mh folder format
7036 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7039 @kindex O v (Summary)
7040 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7041 Save the current article in a VM folder
7042 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7046 @kindex O p (Summary)
7048 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7049 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7050 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7053 @kindex O P (Summary)
7054 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7055 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7056 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7057 external program Muttprint (see
7058 @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/}). The program name and
7059 options to use is controlled by the variable
7060 @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}. (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7064 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7065 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7066 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7067 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7068 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7069 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7070 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7071 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7072 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7073 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7074 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7075 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7079 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7080 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7081 gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
7082 functions below, or you can create your own.
7086 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7087 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7088 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7089 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7090 This is the default format, @dfn{babyl}. Uses the function in the
7091 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7092 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7094 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7095 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7096 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7097 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7098 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7099 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7101 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7102 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7103 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7104 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7105 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7106 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7107 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7109 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7110 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7111 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7112 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7113 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7114 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7116 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7117 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7118 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7119 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7120 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7122 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7123 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7124 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7125 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7126 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7129 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7130 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7131 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7132 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7133 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7135 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7136 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7137 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7138 reader to use this setting.
7141 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7142 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7143 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7144 @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7147 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7148 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7149 available functions that generate names:
7153 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7154 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7155 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7157 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7158 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7159 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7161 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7162 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7163 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7165 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7166 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7167 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7169 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7170 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7171 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7174 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7175 You can have gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7176 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7177 save articles related to gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7178 related to VM in @code{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7182 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7183 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7184 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7185 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7188 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7189 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7190 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7191 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7192 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7193 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7194 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7195 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7196 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7198 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7199 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7200 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7201 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7203 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7204 means that gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7205 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7208 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7209 lots of mail groups called things like
7210 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7211 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7212 following will do just that:
7215 (defun my-save-name (group)
7216 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7217 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7219 (setq gnus-split-methods
7220 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7225 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7226 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7227 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7228 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7229 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7230 all the files in the top level directory
7231 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7232 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7233 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7234 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7236 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7237 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7238 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7239 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7240 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7243 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7247 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; to get a hierarchy
7248 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7249 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; no encoding
7252 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7253 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7254 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7255 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7258 @node Decoding Articles
7259 @section Decoding Articles
7260 @cindex decoding articles
7262 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7263 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7266 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7267 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7268 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7269 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7270 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7271 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7275 @cindex article series
7276 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7277 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7278 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7279 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7280 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7282 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7283 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7284 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7286 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, gnus
7287 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7288 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7290 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7291 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7292 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7295 @node Uuencoded Articles
7296 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7298 @cindex uuencoded articles
7303 @kindex X u (Summary)
7304 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7305 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7306 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7309 @kindex X U (Summary)
7310 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7311 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7312 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7315 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7316 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7317 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7320 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7321 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7322 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7323 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7327 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7328 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7329 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7330 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7331 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7333 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7334 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7335 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7336 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7339 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7340 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7341 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7342 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7343 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7344 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7348 @node Shell Archives
7349 @subsection Shell Archives
7351 @cindex shell archives
7352 @cindex shared articles
7354 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7355 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7356 some commands to deal with these:
7361 @kindex X s (Summary)
7362 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7363 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7366 @kindex X S (Summary)
7367 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7368 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7371 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7372 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7373 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7376 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7377 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7378 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7379 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7383 @node PostScript Files
7384 @subsection PostScript Files
7390 @kindex X p (Summary)
7391 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7392 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7395 @kindex X P (Summary)
7396 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7397 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7398 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7401 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7402 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7403 View the current PostScript series
7404 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7407 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7408 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7409 View and save the current PostScript series
7410 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7415 @subsection Other Files
7419 @kindex X o (Summary)
7420 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7421 Save the current series
7422 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7425 @kindex X b (Summary)
7426 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7427 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7428 doesn't really work yet.
7432 @node Decoding Variables
7433 @subsection Decoding Variables
7435 Adjective, not verb.
7438 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7439 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7440 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7444 @node Rule Variables
7445 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7446 @cindex rule variables
7448 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7449 variables are of the form
7452 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7459 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7460 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7462 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7463 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @samp{.au} sound file, you could
7466 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7467 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7470 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7471 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7472 This variable is consulted if gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7473 user and default view rules.
7475 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7476 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7477 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7482 @node Other Decode Variables
7483 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7486 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7488 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7489 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7490 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7491 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7492 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7496 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7497 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7500 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7501 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7502 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7505 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7506 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7507 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7508 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7509 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7512 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7513 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7514 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7516 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7517 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7518 Files with a @sc{mime} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7519 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7520 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @sc{mime} package (yet), so this is slightly
7523 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7524 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7525 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7527 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7528 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7529 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7530 looking for files to display.
7532 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7533 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7534 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7537 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7538 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7539 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7542 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7543 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7544 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7547 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7548 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7549 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7552 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7553 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7554 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7555 decoded articles as unread.
7557 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7558 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7559 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7560 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7562 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7563 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7564 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7566 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7567 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7569 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7570 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @sc{mime}
7571 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7572 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7574 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7575 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7576 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7577 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7578 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7579 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7580 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7581 simply dropped them.
7586 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7587 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7591 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7592 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
7593 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
7594 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
7595 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
7596 for you when you post the article.
7598 @item gnus-uu-post-length
7599 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
7600 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
7601 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
7603 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
7604 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
7605 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
7606 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
7607 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
7608 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
7609 think that counts...) Default is @code{nil}.
7611 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7612 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
7613 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
7614 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
7615 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
7616 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
7617 Default is @code{t}.
7623 @subsection Viewing Files
7624 @cindex viewing files
7625 @cindex pseudo-articles
7627 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, gnus will attempt
7628 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
7629 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
7630 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, gnus will
7631 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
7632 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
7633 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
7635 Finally, gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
7636 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
7637 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
7638 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
7640 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
7641 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
7642 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
7644 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
7645 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
7646 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
7647 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
7648 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
7650 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
7651 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
7652 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
7653 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
7654 a list of parameters to that command.
7656 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
7657 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
7658 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
7660 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
7661 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
7662 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
7665 @node Article Treatment
7666 @section Article Treatment
7668 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
7669 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
7670 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
7671 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
7672 these articles easier.
7675 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
7676 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
7677 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
7678 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
7679 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
7680 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
7681 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
7682 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
7683 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
7684 * Article Miscellania:: Various other stuff.
7688 @node Article Highlighting
7689 @subsection Article Highlighting
7690 @cindex highlighting
7692 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
7693 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
7698 @kindex W H a (Summary)
7699 @findex gnus-article-highlight
7700 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
7701 Do much highlighting of the current article
7702 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
7703 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
7706 @kindex W H h (Summary)
7707 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
7708 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
7709 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
7710 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
7711 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
7712 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
7713 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
7714 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
7715 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
7716 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
7717 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
7720 @kindex W H c (Summary)
7721 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
7722 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
7724 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
7727 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
7729 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
7730 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
7731 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
7733 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
7734 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
7735 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
7737 @item gnus-cite-face-list
7738 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
7739 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
7740 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
7741 gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
7742 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
7744 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
7745 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
7746 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
7748 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7749 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7750 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
7752 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7753 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7754 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
7755 that it's a citation.
7757 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7758 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7759 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
7761 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7762 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7763 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
7765 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
7766 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
7767 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
7768 cited text belonging to the attribution.
7774 @kindex W H s (Summary)
7775 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
7776 @vindex gnus-signature-face
7777 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
7778 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
7779 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
7780 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
7781 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
7786 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
7789 @node Article Fontisizing
7790 @subsection Article Fontisizing
7792 @cindex article emphasis
7794 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
7795 @kindex W e (Summary)
7796 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
7797 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
7798 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
7799 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
7801 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
7802 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
7803 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
7804 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
7805 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
7806 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
7807 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
7808 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
7812 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
7813 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
7814 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
7823 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
7824 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
7825 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
7826 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
7827 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
7828 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
7829 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
7830 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
7831 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
7832 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
7833 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
7834 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
7835 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
7837 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
7838 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
7839 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
7843 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
7846 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
7848 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
7849 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
7850 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
7851 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
7853 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
7856 @node Article Hiding
7857 @subsection Article Hiding
7858 @cindex article hiding
7860 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
7861 too much cruft in most articles.
7866 @kindex W W a (Summary)
7867 @findex gnus-article-hide
7868 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
7869 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
7870 headers, PGP, cited text and the signature.
7873 @kindex W W h (Summary)
7874 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
7875 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
7879 @kindex W W b (Summary)
7880 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
7881 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
7882 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
7885 @kindex W W s (Summary)
7886 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
7887 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
7891 @kindex W W l (Summary)
7892 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
7893 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7894 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
7895 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
7896 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
7897 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
7898 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
7902 @item gnus-list-identifiers
7903 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7904 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
7905 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
7910 @kindex W W p (Summary)
7911 @findex gnus-article-hide-pgp
7912 @vindex gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7913 Hide @sc{pgp} signatures (@code{gnus-article-hide-pgp}). The
7914 @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook} hook will be run after a @sc{pgp}
7915 signature has been hidden. For example, to automatically verify
7916 articles that have signatures in them do:
7918 ;;; Hide pgp cruft if any.
7920 (setq gnus-treat-strip-pgp t)
7922 ;;; After hiding pgp, verify the message;
7923 ;;; only happens if pgp signature is found.
7925 (add-hook 'gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7928 (set-buffer gnus-original-article-buffer)
7933 @kindex W W P (Summary)
7934 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
7935 Hide @sc{pem} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
7936 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
7939 @kindex W W B (Summary)
7940 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
7943 @cindex stripping advertisements
7944 @cindex advertisements
7945 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
7946 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
7947 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
7948 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
7949 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
7950 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
7951 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
7952 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
7953 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
7954 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
7958 @kindex W W c (Summary)
7959 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
7960 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
7961 customizing the hiding:
7965 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7966 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7967 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7968 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7969 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
7970 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
7971 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
7976 Starting point of the hidden text.
7978 Ending point of the hidden text.
7980 Number of characters in the hidden region.
7982 Number of lines of hidden text.
7985 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
7986 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
7987 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
7988 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
7989 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
7994 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
7995 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
7997 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
7998 following two variables:
8001 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8002 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8003 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8004 50), hide the cited text.
8006 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8007 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8008 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8013 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8014 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8015 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8016 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8017 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8018 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8022 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8023 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8024 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8026 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8027 citation customization.
8029 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8033 @node Article Washing
8034 @subsection Article Washing
8036 @cindex article washing
8038 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8039 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8041 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8042 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8045 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8046 articles by default.
8051 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8052 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8056 @kindex W l (Summary)
8057 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8058 Remove page breaks from the current article
8059 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8063 @kindex W r (Summary)
8064 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8065 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8066 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8067 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8068 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8069 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8071 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8072 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8073 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8074 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8078 @kindex W t (Summary)
8080 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8081 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8082 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8085 @kindex W v (Summary)
8086 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8087 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8088 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8091 @kindex W m (Summary)
8092 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-mime
8093 Toggle whether to run the article through @sc{mime} before displaying
8094 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-mime}).
8097 @kindex W o (Summary)
8098 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8099 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8102 @kindex W d (Summary)
8103 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8104 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8106 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8108 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8109 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8110 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8111 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8114 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8115 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8116 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8117 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8120 @kindex W k (Summary)
8121 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8122 @cindex Outlook Express
8123 Deuglify broken Outlook (Express) articles and redisplay
8124 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8127 @kindex W w (Summary)
8128 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8129 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8131 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8135 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8136 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8137 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8140 @kindex W C (Summary)
8141 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8142 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8143 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8146 @kindex W c (Summary)
8147 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8148 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8149 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8150 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8151 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8154 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8155 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8156 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}).
8157 Base64 is one common @sc{mime} encoding employed when sending non-ASCII
8158 (i. e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is usually done
8159 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8160 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding has
8162 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8165 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8166 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8167 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8168 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8169 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8172 @kindex W u (Summary)
8173 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8174 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8175 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8176 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8177 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8180 @kindex W h (Summary)
8181 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8182 Treat @sc{html} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8183 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8184 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @sc{html}.
8186 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8188 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8189 The default is to use the function specified by
8190 @code{mm-inline-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Customization, , , emacs-mime})
8191 to convert the @sc{html}, but this is controlled by the
8192 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8200 Use emacs-w3m (see @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/} for more
8204 Use Links (see @uref{http://artax.karlin.mff.cuni.cz/~mikulas/links/}).
8207 Use Lynx (see @uref{http://lynx.browser.org/}).
8210 Use html2text -- a simple @sc{html} converter included with Gnus.
8215 @kindex W b (Summary)
8216 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8217 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8218 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8221 @kindex W B (Summary)
8222 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8223 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8224 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8227 @kindex W p (Summary)
8228 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8229 Verify a signed control message (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}).
8230 Control messages such as @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are
8231 usually signed by the hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the PGP
8232 public key of the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8233 message.@footnote{PGP keys for many hierarchies are available at
8234 @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8237 @kindex W s (Summary)
8238 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8239 Verify a signed (PGP, @sc{pgp/mime} or @sc{s/mime}) message
8240 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8243 @kindex W a (Summary)
8244 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8245 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8246 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8249 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8250 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8251 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8252 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8255 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8256 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8257 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8258 lines with a single empty line.
8259 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8262 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8263 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8264 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8265 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8268 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8269 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8270 Do all the three commands above
8271 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8274 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8275 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8276 Remove all blank lines
8277 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8280 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8281 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8282 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8283 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8286 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8287 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8288 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8289 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8293 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8296 @node Article Header
8297 @subsection Article Header
8299 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8304 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8305 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8306 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8309 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8310 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8311 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8312 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8315 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8316 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-header
8317 Fold all the message headers
8318 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8322 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8323 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8324 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8329 @node Article Buttons
8330 @subsection Article Buttons
8333 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8334 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8335 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8336 button on these references.
8338 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8339 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses and Message-IDs. This is controlled by
8340 two variables, one that handles article bodies and one that handles
8345 @item gnus-button-alist
8346 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8347 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8350 (REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
8356 All text that match this regular expression will be considered an
8357 external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches embedded URLs:
8358 @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a variable containing a
8359 regexp, useful variables to use include @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}.
8362 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8363 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8364 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8367 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8368 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8369 avoid false matches.
8372 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8375 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8376 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8380 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8383 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8386 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8387 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8388 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8389 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8390 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8393 (HEADER REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
8396 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8398 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8399 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8400 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8401 default values of the variables above.
8403 @item gnus-article-button-face
8404 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8405 Face used on buttons.
8407 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8408 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8409 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8413 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8417 @subsection Article Date
8419 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
8420 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
8421 when the article was sent.
8426 @kindex W T u (Summary)
8427 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
8428 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
8429 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
8432 @kindex W T i (Summary)
8433 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
8435 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
8436 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
8439 @kindex W T l (Summary)
8440 @findex gnus-article-date-local
8441 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
8444 @kindex W T p (Summary)
8445 @findex gnus-article-date-english
8446 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
8447 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
8450 @kindex W T s (Summary)
8451 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
8452 @findex gnus-article-date-user
8453 @findex format-time-string
8454 Display the date using a user-defined format
8455 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
8456 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
8457 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
8458 for a list of possible format specs.
8461 @kindex W T e (Summary)
8462 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
8463 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
8464 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
8465 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
8466 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
8469 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
8472 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
8473 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
8476 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
8477 into wonderful absurdities.
8479 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
8482 (gnus-start-date-timer)
8485 in your @file{.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
8486 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
8490 @kindex W T o (Summary)
8491 @findex gnus-article-date-original
8492 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
8493 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
8494 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
8495 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
8496 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
8500 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
8501 preferred format automatically.
8504 @node Article Display
8505 @subsection Article Display
8510 These commands add various frivolous display gimmics to the article
8511 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
8513 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
8514 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
8516 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
8517 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
8519 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
8520 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
8522 All these functions are toggles--if the elements already exist,
8527 @kindex W D x (Summary)
8528 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
8529 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
8530 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
8533 @kindex W D s (Summary)
8534 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
8535 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
8538 @kindex W D f (Summary)
8539 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
8540 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
8543 @kindex W D m (Summary)
8544 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
8545 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
8546 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
8549 @kindex W D n (Summary)
8550 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
8551 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
8552 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
8555 @kindex W D D (Summary)
8556 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
8557 Remove all images from the article buffer
8558 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
8564 @node Article Signature
8565 @subsection Article Signature
8567 @cindex article signature
8569 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8570 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
8571 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
8572 that says what is to be considered a signature is
8573 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
8574 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
8575 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
8576 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
8577 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
8580 (setq gnus-signature-separator
8581 '("^-- $" ; The standard
8582 "^-- *$" ; A common mangling
8583 "^-------*$" ; Many people just use a looong
8584 ; line of dashes. Shame!
8585 "^ *--------*$" ; Double-shame!
8586 "^________*$" ; Underscores are also popular
8587 "^========*$")) ; Pervert!
8590 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
8593 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
8594 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
8595 signature when displaying articles.
8599 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
8602 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
8605 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
8606 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
8608 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
8609 in question is not a signature.
8612 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
8613 listed above. Here's an example:
8616 (setq gnus-signature-limit
8617 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
8620 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
8621 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
8622 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
8623 signature after all.
8626 @node Article Miscellania
8627 @subsection Article Miscellania
8631 @kindex A t (Summary)
8632 @findex gnus-article-babel
8633 Translate the article from one language to another
8634 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
8640 @section MIME Commands
8641 @cindex MIME decoding
8643 @cindex viewing attachments
8645 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
8646 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @sc{mime} part''.
8652 @kindex K v (Summary)
8653 View the @sc{mime} part.
8656 @kindex K o (Summary)
8657 Save the @sc{mime} part.
8660 @kindex K c (Summary)
8661 Copy the @sc{mime} part.
8664 @kindex K e (Summary)
8665 View the @sc{mime} part externally.
8668 @kindex K i (Summary)
8669 View the @sc{mime} part internally.
8672 @kindex K | (Summary)
8673 Pipe the @sc{mime} part to an external command.
8676 The rest of these @sc{mime} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
8681 @kindex K b (Summary)
8682 Make all the @sc{mime} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
8683 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
8687 @kindex K m (Summary)
8688 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
8689 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
8690 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
8691 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
8692 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
8695 @kindex X m (Summary)
8696 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
8697 Save all parts matching a @sc{mime} type to a directory
8698 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
8699 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
8702 @kindex M-t (Summary)
8703 @findex gnus-summary-display-buttonized
8704 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
8705 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
8708 @kindex W M w (Summary)
8709 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
8710 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
8713 @kindex W M c (Summary)
8714 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
8715 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
8717 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
8718 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
8719 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
8720 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
8721 include @sc{mime} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
8722 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
8725 @kindex W M v (Summary)
8726 View all the @sc{mime} parts in the current article
8727 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
8734 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
8735 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
8736 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
8737 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
8740 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
8743 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
8747 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
8748 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
8749 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
8750 this list won't have @sc{mime} buttons inserted unless they aren't
8751 displayed or this variable is overriden by
8752 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
8755 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
8756 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
8757 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
8758 this list will have @sc{mime} buttons inserted unless they aren't
8759 displayed. This variable overrides
8760 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
8762 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
8763 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
8764 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} to the default value.
8766 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
8767 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
8768 For each @sc{mime} part, this function will be called with the @sc{mime}
8769 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
8770 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
8771 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
8772 save all jpegs into some directory).
8774 Here's an example function the does the latter:
8777 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
8778 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
8780 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
8781 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
8782 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
8783 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
8784 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
8787 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
8788 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
8789 Alist of @sc{mime} multipart types and functions to handle them.
8791 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
8792 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
8793 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @sc{mime} parts.
8794 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
8796 Ready-made functions include@*
8797 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
8798 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
8799 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
8800 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
8801 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
8802 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
8803 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
8804 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
8805 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
8806 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
8807 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
8808 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
8810 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
8811 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
8813 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
8814 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
8815 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
8818 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
8819 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
8820 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
8821 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
8825 to your @file{.gnus} file.
8834 People use different charsets, and we have @sc{mime} to let us know what
8835 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
8836 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @sc{mime}, and
8837 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
8838 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
8839 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
8840 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
8842 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
8843 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
8844 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
8845 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
8847 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @sc{mime}-aware agents that
8848 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
8849 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
8850 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
8851 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
8852 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
8853 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
8854 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
8856 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
8857 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
8858 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @sc{mime}
8859 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
8860 quoted-printable header encoding.
8862 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
8863 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
8864 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
8868 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
8871 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
8872 means encode all charsets),
8874 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
8875 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
8876 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
8883 @cindex coding system aliases
8884 @cindex preferred charset
8886 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
8888 If there are several @sc{mime} charsets that encode the same Emacs
8889 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
8892 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
8893 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
8896 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
8897 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @sc{mime} charset.
8899 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
8902 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
8905 This will almost do the right thing.
8907 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
8911 (codepage-setup 1251)
8912 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
8916 @node Article Commands
8917 @section Article Commands
8924 @kindex A P (Summary)
8925 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
8926 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
8927 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
8928 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
8929 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
8930 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
8935 @node Summary Sorting
8936 @section Summary Sorting
8937 @cindex summary sorting
8939 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
8940 can't really see why you'd want that.
8945 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
8946 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
8947 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
8950 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
8951 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
8952 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
8955 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
8956 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
8957 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
8960 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
8961 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
8962 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
8965 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
8966 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
8967 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
8970 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
8971 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
8972 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
8975 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
8976 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
8977 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
8980 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
8981 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
8982 Sort using the default sorting method
8983 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
8986 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
8987 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
8988 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
8989 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
8990 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
8994 @node Finding the Parent
8995 @section Finding the Parent
8996 @cindex parent articles
8997 @cindex referring articles
9002 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9003 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9004 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9005 if the current group is fetched by @sc{nntp}, the parent hasn't expired
9006 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9007 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9008 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9009 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9010 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9012 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9013 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9014 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, gnus will fetch the parent, the
9015 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9016 @kbd{-3 ^}, gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9020 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9021 @kindex A R (Summary)
9022 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9023 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9026 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9027 @kindex A T (Summary)
9028 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9029 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9030 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9031 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9032 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9033 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9034 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9036 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9037 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9038 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9039 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9040 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9041 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9044 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9045 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9047 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9048 You can also ask the @sc{nntp} server for an arbitrary article, no
9049 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
9050 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
9051 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
9052 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
9053 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9056 The current select method will be used when fetching by
9057 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
9058 by giving this command a prefix.
9060 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9061 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9062 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9063 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @sc{nntp} method. It
9064 would, perhaps, be best if the @sc{nntp} server you consult is the one
9065 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9068 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9069 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9070 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9073 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9074 then ask Deja if that fails:
9077 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9079 (nnweb "refer" (nnweb-type dejanews))))
9082 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9083 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9084 @code{nnbabyl}, and @code{nnmaildir} are able to locate articles from
9085 any groups, while @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9086 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current group.
9087 (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does not
9088 support this at all.
9091 @node Alternative Approaches
9092 @section Alternative Approaches
9094 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9095 gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9098 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9099 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9104 @subsection Pick and Read
9105 @cindex pick and read
9107 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9108 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9109 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9110 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9112 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9113 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9114 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9115 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9116 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9117 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9119 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9124 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9125 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9126 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9127 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9128 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9129 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9130 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9131 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9134 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9135 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9136 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9137 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9141 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9142 Unpick the thread or article
9143 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9144 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9145 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9146 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9147 the thread or article at that line.
9151 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9152 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9153 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9154 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9155 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9156 will still be visible when you are reading.
9160 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9161 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9162 which is mapped to the same function
9163 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9165 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9168 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9171 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9172 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9174 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9175 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9176 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9178 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9179 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9180 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9181 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9182 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9183 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9184 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9188 @subsection Binary Groups
9189 @cindex binary groups
9191 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9192 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9193 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9194 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9195 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9196 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9197 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9200 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9201 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9202 command, when you have turned on this mode
9203 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9205 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9206 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9210 @section Tree Display
9213 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9214 If you don't like the normal gnus summary display, you might try setting
9215 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9216 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9219 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9222 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9223 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9224 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9226 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9227 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9228 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9229 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9230 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9232 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9233 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9234 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9235 default is @code{modeline}.
9237 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9238 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9239 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9240 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9241 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9242 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9243 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9249 The name of the poster.
9251 The @code{From} header.
9253 The number of the article.
9255 The opening bracket.
9257 The closing bracket.
9262 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9264 Variables related to the display are:
9267 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9268 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9269 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9270 ``sparse'' articles. The format is @code{((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9271 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close}) (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))}, and the
9272 default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9274 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9275 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9276 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9277 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9281 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9282 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9283 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, gnus will try to keep the tree
9284 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other gnus
9285 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9286 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9287 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9288 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9289 other windows displayed next to it.
9291 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9295 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9296 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9299 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9300 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9301 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9302 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9303 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9304 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9305 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9309 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9312 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9322 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
9326 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
9327 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
9329 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
9331 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
9336 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
9337 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
9338 following to your @file{.gnus.el} file:
9341 (setq gnus-use-trees t
9342 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9343 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
9344 (gnus-add-configuration
9348 (summary 0.75 point)
9353 @xref{Window Layout}.
9356 @node Mail Group Commands
9357 @section Mail Group Commands
9358 @cindex mail group commands
9360 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
9361 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
9363 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
9364 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9369 @kindex B e (Summary)
9370 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
9371 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
9372 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
9373 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
9374 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
9377 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
9378 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
9379 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
9380 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
9381 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
9382 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
9385 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
9386 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
9387 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
9388 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
9389 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
9390 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
9393 @kindex B m (Summary)
9395 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
9396 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
9397 Move the article from one mail group to another
9398 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9399 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9402 @kindex B c (Summary)
9404 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
9405 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
9406 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
9407 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
9408 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
9411 @kindex B B (Summary)
9412 @cindex crosspost mail
9413 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
9414 Crosspost the current article to some other group
9415 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
9416 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
9417 be properly updated.
9420 @kindex B i (Summary)
9421 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
9422 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
9423 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
9424 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
9427 @kindex B I (Summary)
9428 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
9429 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
9430 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
9431 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
9434 @kindex B r (Summary)
9435 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
9436 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
9437 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
9438 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
9439 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
9440 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
9441 (which is the default).
9445 @kindex B w (Summary)
9447 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
9448 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
9449 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
9450 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
9451 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
9452 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
9453 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, gnus won't re-highlight the article.
9456 @kindex B q (Summary)
9457 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
9458 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
9459 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
9460 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
9463 @kindex B t (Summary)
9464 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
9465 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
9466 when repooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
9469 @kindex B p (Summary)
9470 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
9471 Some people have a tendency to send you "courtesy" copies when they
9472 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
9473 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
9474 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
9475 article from your news server (or rather, from
9476 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
9477 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
9478 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
9479 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
9480 just not have arrived yet.
9483 @kindex K E (Summary)
9484 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
9485 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
9486 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
9487 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
9488 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
9492 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
9493 @cindex moving articles
9494 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have gnus
9495 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
9496 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
9497 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
9498 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
9499 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
9500 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
9503 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
9504 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
9505 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
9506 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
9510 @node Various Summary Stuff
9511 @section Various Summary Stuff
9514 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
9515 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
9516 * Summary Generation Commands::
9517 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
9521 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
9522 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
9523 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
9525 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
9526 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
9527 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
9528 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
9529 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
9530 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
9533 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
9534 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
9535 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
9536 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
9537 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
9539 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
9540 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
9541 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
9544 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
9545 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
9546 When gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
9547 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
9548 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
9549 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
9550 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), gnus will rename the
9551 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
9552 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
9553 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
9555 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
9556 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
9557 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
9558 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
9559 list of articles to be selected.
9561 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
9562 the list in one particular group:
9565 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
9566 (if (string= group "some.group")
9567 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
9571 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
9572 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
9573 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
9574 variables and their default values (when the default values are not
9575 nil), that should be made global while the summary buffer is active.
9576 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
9577 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
9578 buffers. For example:
9581 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
9582 '(message-use-followup-to
9583 (gnus-visible-headers .
9584 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
9590 @node Summary Group Information
9591 @subsection Summary Group Information
9596 @kindex H f (Summary)
9597 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
9598 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
9599 Try to fetch the FAQ (list of frequently asked questions) for the
9600 current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the
9601 FAQ from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory
9602 on a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
9603 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
9604 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will probably
9605 be used for fetching the file.
9608 @kindex H d (Summary)
9609 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
9610 Give a brief description of the current group
9611 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
9612 rereading the description from the server.
9615 @kindex H h (Summary)
9616 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
9617 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
9618 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
9621 @kindex H i (Summary)
9622 @findex gnus-info-find-node
9623 Go to the gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
9627 @node Searching for Articles
9628 @subsection Searching for Articles
9633 @kindex M-s (Summary)
9634 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
9635 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
9636 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
9639 @kindex M-r (Summary)
9640 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
9641 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
9642 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
9646 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
9647 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
9648 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
9649 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
9650 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
9651 search backward instead.
9653 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string #} will put the process mark on
9654 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
9657 @kindex M-& (Summary)
9658 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
9659 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
9660 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
9663 @node Summary Generation Commands
9664 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
9669 @kindex Y g (Summary)
9670 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
9671 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
9674 @kindex Y c (Summary)
9675 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
9676 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
9677 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
9682 @node Really Various Summary Commands
9683 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
9689 @kindex C-d (Summary)
9690 @kindex A D (Summary)
9691 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
9692 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
9693 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
9694 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
9695 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
9696 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
9697 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
9698 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
9702 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
9703 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
9704 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
9705 several documents into one biiig group
9706 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
9707 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
9708 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
9709 command understands the process/prefix convention
9710 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9713 @kindex C-t (Summary)
9714 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
9715 Toggle truncation of summary lines
9716 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
9717 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
9718 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
9722 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
9723 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
9724 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
9727 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
9728 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
9729 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
9730 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
9733 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
9734 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
9735 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
9736 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
9741 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
9742 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
9743 @cindex summary exit
9744 @cindex exiting groups
9746 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
9747 group and return you to the group buffer.
9753 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
9755 @findex gnus-summary-exit
9756 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
9757 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
9758 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
9759 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
9760 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
9761 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
9762 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
9763 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
9764 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
9765 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
9769 @kindex Z E (Summary)
9771 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
9772 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
9773 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
9777 @kindex Z c (Summary)
9779 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
9780 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
9781 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
9782 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
9785 @kindex Z C (Summary)
9786 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
9787 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
9788 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
9791 @kindex Z n (Summary)
9792 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
9793 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
9794 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
9797 @kindex Z R (Summary)
9798 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
9799 Exit this group, and then enter it again
9800 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
9801 all articles, both read and unread.
9805 @kindex Z G (Summary)
9806 @kindex M-g (Summary)
9807 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
9808 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
9809 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
9810 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
9811 articles, both read and unread.
9814 @kindex Z N (Summary)
9815 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
9816 Exit the group and go to the next group
9817 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
9820 @kindex Z P (Summary)
9821 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
9822 Exit the group and go to the previous group
9823 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
9826 @kindex Z s (Summary)
9827 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
9828 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
9829 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
9830 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
9831 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
9834 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
9835 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
9836 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
9837 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
9839 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
9840 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
9841 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
9842 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
9843 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
9844 If you do that, gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
9845 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
9846 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
9847 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
9848 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
9849 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
9850 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
9852 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
9854 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
9855 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
9856 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
9857 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
9858 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
9859 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
9860 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
9861 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
9862 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
9865 @node Crosspost Handling
9866 @section Crosspost Handling
9870 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
9871 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
9872 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
9873 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
9874 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
9875 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
9878 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
9879 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
9880 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
9881 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
9882 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
9884 @cindex cross-posting
9887 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
9888 correctly is if you use an @sc{nntp} server that supports @sc{xover}
9889 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
9890 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @sc{nov} lines. This is
9891 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
9892 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
9893 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
9894 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
9895 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
9896 the cross reference mechanism.
9898 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
9899 @cindex overview.fmt
9900 To check whether your @sc{nntp} server includes the @code{Xref} header
9901 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
9902 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
9903 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
9904 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
9905 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
9908 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
9909 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
9910 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
9915 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
9918 @node Duplicate Suppression
9919 @section Duplicate Suppression
9921 By default, gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
9922 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
9923 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
9924 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
9929 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
9930 is evil and not very common.
9933 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
9934 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
9937 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
9938 different @sc{nntp} servers.
9941 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
9944 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
9945 well, but these four are the most common situations.
9947 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
9948 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
9949 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
9950 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
9951 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
9952 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
9953 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
9956 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
9957 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
9958 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
9959 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
9960 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
9964 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
9965 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
9966 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
9968 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
9969 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
9970 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
9971 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
9972 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single gnus
9973 session are suppressed.
9975 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
9976 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
9977 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
9978 suppression list. The default is 10000.
9980 @item gnus-duplicate-file
9981 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
9982 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
9983 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
9986 If you have a tendency to stop and start gnus often, setting
9987 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
9988 you leave gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
9989 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
9990 so that means that if you stop and start gnus often, you should set
9991 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
9992 to you to figure out, I think.
9997 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
9998 The formats that are supported are PGP, @sc{pgp/mime} and @sc{s/mime},
9999 however you need some external programs to get things to work:
10003 To handle PGP messages, you have to install mailcrypt or gpg.el as
10004 well as a OpenPGP implementation (such as GnuPG).
10007 To handle @sc{s/mime} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10008 or newer is recommended.
10012 More information on how to set things up can be found in the message
10013 manual (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10016 @item mm-verify-option
10017 @vindex mm-verify-option
10018 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10019 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10020 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10022 @item mm-decrypt-option
10023 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10024 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10025 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10026 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10031 @section Mailing List
10033 @kindex A M (summary)
10034 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10035 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10036 either add a `to-list' group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10037 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10038 summary buffer, or say:
10041 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-mailing-list-mode)
10044 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10049 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10050 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10051 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10054 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10055 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10056 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10059 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10060 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10061 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10065 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10066 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10067 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10070 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10071 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10072 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10075 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10076 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10077 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10081 @node Article Buffer
10082 @chapter Article Buffer
10083 @cindex article buffer
10085 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10086 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10087 tell gnus otherwise.
10090 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10091 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
10092 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10093 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10094 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10098 @node Hiding Headers
10099 @section Hiding Headers
10100 @cindex hiding headers
10101 @cindex deleting headers
10103 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10104 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10106 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10107 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10108 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10109 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10110 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10111 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10112 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseum---and you'll probably want to get rid
10113 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10114 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10116 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10120 @item gnus-visible-headers
10121 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10122 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10123 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10124 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10126 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10127 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10130 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10133 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10136 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10137 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10138 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10139 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10140 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10141 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10143 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} field
10144 and the @code{Xref} field, you might say:
10147 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10150 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10153 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10154 variable will have no effect.
10158 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10159 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10160 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10161 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10162 the headers are to be displayed.
10164 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10165 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10168 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10171 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10172 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10174 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10175 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10176 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10177 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10178 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10179 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead is
10180 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10183 These conditions are:
10186 Remove all empty headers.
10188 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10189 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10191 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same address as the
10192 @code{From} header.
10194 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10197 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10198 the current groups's @code{to-address} parameter.
10200 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10203 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10205 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10208 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10211 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10212 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10215 This is also the default value for this variable.
10219 @section Using MIME
10222 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10223 while people stand around yawning.
10225 @sc{mime}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10226 while all newsreaders die of fear.
10228 @sc{mime} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
10229 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
10230 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
10232 @vindex gnus-show-mime
10233 @vindex gnus-article-display-method-for-mime
10234 @findex gnus-article-display-mime-message
10235 Gnus handles @sc{mime} by pushing the articles through
10236 @code{gnus-article-display-method-for-mime}, which is
10237 @code{gnus-article-display-mime-message} by default. This function
10238 calls the @sc{semi} MIME-View program to actually do the work. For more
10239 information on @sc{semi} MIME-View, see its manual page (however it is
10240 not existed yet, sorry).
10242 Set @code{gnus-show-mime} to @code{t} if you want to use
10243 @sc{mime} all the time. If you have @code{gnus-show-mime} set, then
10244 you'll see some unfortunate display glitches in the article buffer.
10245 These can't be avoided.
10247 In GNUS or Gnus, it might be best to just use the toggling functions
10248 from the summary buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance,
10249 you enter the group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it,
10250 @sc{mime} has decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible
10251 sing-a-long song comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find
10252 the volume button, because there isn't one, and people are starting to
10253 look at you, and you try to stop the program, but you can't, and you
10254 can't find the program to control the volume, and everybody else in the
10255 room suddenly decides to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel
10258 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
10260 To avoid such kind of situation, gnus stops to use
10261 @code{metamail-buffer}. So now, you can set @code{gnus-show-mime} to
10262 non-@code{nil} every-time, then you can push button in the article
10263 buffer when there are nobody else.
10265 Also see @pxref{MIME Commands}.
10268 @node Customizing Articles
10269 @section Customizing Articles
10270 @cindex article customization
10272 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
10273 exist. You can call these functions interactively, or you can have them
10274 called automatically when you select the articles.
10276 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
10277 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
10278 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
10279 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
10281 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
10282 for sensible values.
10286 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
10289 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
10292 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
10295 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
10298 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
10302 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
10303 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
10304 regexps in the list.
10307 A list where the first element is not a string:
10309 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
10310 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
10311 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
10315 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
10319 @code{mime}: Do this treatment if the value of @code{gnus-show-mime}' is
10324 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
10325 to the fact that some messages are @sc{mime} multipart articles that may
10326 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
10327 considered to contain just a single part.
10329 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
10330 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
10331 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
10332 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
10333 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
10334 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
10335 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
10337 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
10338 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
10339 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
10340 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
10343 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
10344 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
10346 @xref{Article Buttons}.
10348 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
10349 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
10350 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
10351 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
10352 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
10353 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
10354 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
10355 @item gnus-treat-strip-pgp (t, last, integer)
10356 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
10357 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
10358 @item gnus-treat-decode-article-as-default-mime-charset (t, integer)
10360 @xref{Article Washing}.
10362 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
10363 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
10364 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
10365 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
10366 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
10367 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
10368 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
10370 @xref{Article Date}.
10372 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
10373 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
10374 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
10378 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
10380 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
10382 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
10383 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
10384 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
10388 @item gnus-treat-display-xface (head)
10392 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
10393 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
10394 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
10395 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
10396 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
10397 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
10398 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
10399 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
10401 @xref{Article Hiding}.
10403 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
10404 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
10405 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
10407 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
10409 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
10410 @item gnus-treat-translate
10411 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
10413 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
10414 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
10415 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
10416 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
10418 @xref{Article Header}.
10423 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
10424 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
10425 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
10426 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
10427 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
10431 @node Article Keymap
10432 @section Article Keymap
10434 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
10435 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
10436 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
10437 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
10440 A few additional keystrokes are available:
10445 @kindex SPACE (Article)
10446 @findex gnus-article-next-page
10447 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
10450 @kindex DEL (Article)
10451 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
10452 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
10455 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
10456 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
10457 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
10458 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
10459 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
10462 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
10463 @findex gnus-article-mail
10464 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
10465 given a prefix, include the mail.
10468 @kindex s (Article)
10469 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
10470 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
10471 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
10474 @kindex ? (Article)
10475 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
10476 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
10477 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
10480 @kindex TAB (Article)
10481 @findex gnus-article-next-button
10482 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
10483 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
10486 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
10487 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
10488 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
10491 @kindex R (Article)
10492 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
10493 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
10494 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
10495 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
10499 @kindex F (Article)
10500 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
10501 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
10502 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
10503 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
10511 @section Misc Article
10515 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
10516 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
10517 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
10518 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
10521 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
10522 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
10524 Hook used to decode @sc{mime} articles. The default value is
10525 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
10527 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
10528 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
10529 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
10530 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
10531 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
10532 the contents of the article buffer.
10534 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
10535 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
10536 Hook called in article mode buffers.
10538 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
10539 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
10540 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
10541 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
10543 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
10544 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
10545 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
10546 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
10547 accepts the same format specifications as that variable, with two
10553 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
10554 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
10555 performed. The characters and their meaning:
10560 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
10563 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
10566 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
10567 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
10568 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
10571 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
10574 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
10577 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
10582 The number of @sc{mime} parts in the article.
10586 @vindex gnus-break-pages
10588 @item gnus-break-pages
10589 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
10590 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
10591 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
10592 paging will not be done.
10594 @item gnus-page-delimiter
10595 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
10596 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
10601 @node Composing Messages
10602 @chapter Composing Messages
10603 @cindex composing messages
10606 @cindex sending mail
10611 @cindex using s/mime
10612 @cindex using smime
10614 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
10615 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
10616 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
10617 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
10618 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
10619 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
10622 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
10623 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
10624 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
10625 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
10626 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
10627 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
10628 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
10629 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
10632 Also see @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
10633 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
10639 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
10642 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
10643 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
10644 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
10645 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched.
10647 @item gnus-add-to-list
10648 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
10649 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
10650 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
10652 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
10653 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
10654 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus requests confirmation when replying to news.
10655 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
10656 press R anyway, this variable might be for you.
10661 @node Posting Server
10662 @section Posting Server
10664 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
10665 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
10667 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
10669 It can be quite complicated.
10671 @vindex gnus-post-method
10672 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
10673 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
10674 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
10675 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
10676 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
10677 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
10678 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
10679 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
10680 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
10683 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
10686 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
10687 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
10688 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
10689 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
10691 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
10692 gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
10694 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
10695 If that's the case, gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
10698 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
10699 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
10701 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
10702 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
10703 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
10704 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
10705 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @sc{smtp}
10706 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
10707 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
10708 package correctly. An example:
10711 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
10712 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
10715 Other possible choises for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
10716 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
10717 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
10719 @node Mail and Post
10720 @section Mail and Post
10722 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
10726 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
10727 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
10728 @cindex mailing lists
10730 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
10731 gatewayed to the @sc{nntp} server, you can read those groups without
10732 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
10733 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
10734 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
10735 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
10736 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
10737 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
10738 still a pain, though.
10742 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
10743 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
10744 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
10747 @findex ispell-message
10749 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
10752 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
10753 you're in, you could say something like the following:
10756 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
10760 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
10761 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
10763 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
10766 Modify to suit your needs.
10769 @node Archived Messages
10770 @section Archived Messages
10771 @cindex archived messages
10772 @cindex sent messages
10774 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
10775 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
10776 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
10777 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
10780 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
10781 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
10784 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
10785 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server gnus is to
10786 use to store sent messages. The default is:
10789 (nnfolder "archive"
10790 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
10791 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
10792 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
10793 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
10796 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
10797 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
10798 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
10799 directory chosen, you could say something like:
10802 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
10803 '(nnfolder "archive"
10804 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
10805 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
10806 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
10809 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
10811 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
10812 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
10813 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
10815 This variable can be used to do the following:
10820 Messages will be saved in that group.
10822 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
10823 message will not be stored in the select method given by
10824 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
10825 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
10826 has the default value shown above. Then setting
10827 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
10828 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
10829 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
10833 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
10835 an alist of regexps, functions and forms
10836 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
10839 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
10844 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
10846 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
10849 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
10851 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
10854 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
10856 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
10857 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
10858 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
10859 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
10862 More complex stuff:
10864 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
10865 '((if (message-news-p)
10870 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
10871 messages in one file per month:
10874 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
10875 '((if (message-news-p)
10877 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
10880 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
10881 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
10883 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
10884 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
10885 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
10886 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
10887 gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
10888 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
10889 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
10890 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
10891 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
10892 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
10894 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
10895 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
10896 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
10897 this will disable archiving.
10900 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
10901 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
10902 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
10903 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
10904 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
10907 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
10908 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
10909 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
10912 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
10913 but the latter is the preferred method.
10915 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
10916 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
10917 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
10919 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
10920 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
10921 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
10922 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
10923 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
10924 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
10925 changed in the future.
10930 @node Posting Styles
10931 @section Posting Styles
10932 @cindex posting styles
10935 All them variables, they make my head swim.
10937 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
10938 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
10939 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
10942 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
10943 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
10944 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
10945 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
10946 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
10951 (signature "Peace and happiness")
10952 (organization "What me?"))
10954 (signature "Death to everybody"))
10955 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
10956 (organization "Emacs is it")))
10959 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
10960 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
10961 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
10962 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
10963 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
10964 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
10965 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
10966 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
10968 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
10969 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
10970 If it is the form @code{(header MATCH REGEXP)}, then Gnus will look in
10971 the original article for a header whose name is MATCH and compare that
10972 REGEXP. MATCH and REGEXP are strings. If it's a function symbol, that
10973 function will be called with no arguments. If it's a variable symbol,
10974 then the variable will be referenced. If it's a list, then that list
10975 will be @code{eval}ed. In any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil}
10976 value, then the style is said to @dfn{match}.
10978 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
10979 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. The
10980 attribute name can be one of @code{signature}, @code{signature-file},
10981 @code{x-face-file}, @code{address} (overriding
10982 @code{user-mail-address}), @code{name} (overriding
10983 @code{(user-full-name)}) or @code{body}. The attribute name can also
10984 be a string or a symbol. In that case, this will be used as a header
10985 name, and the value will be inserted in the headers of the article; if
10986 the value is @code{nil}, the header name will be removed. If the
10987 attribute name is @code{eval}, the form is evaluated, and the result
10990 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
10991 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
10992 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
10993 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
10994 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
10995 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
10996 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
10997 references chars lines xref extra.
10999 @vindex message-reply-headers
11001 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11002 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11003 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11005 @findex message-mail-p
11006 @findex message-news-p
11008 So here's a new example:
11011 (setq gnus-posting-styles
11013 (signature-file "~/.signature")
11015 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
11016 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
11018 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
11019 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; A form
11020 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
11021 (message-news-p ;; A function symbol
11022 (signature my-news-signature))
11023 (window-system ;; A value symbol
11024 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
11025 ;; If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.
11026 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
11027 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
11028 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; A user defined function
11029 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
11030 (address "user@@bar.foo")
11031 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
11032 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
11034 (From (save-excursion
11035 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
11036 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
11038 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
11041 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
11042 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
11043 if you fill many roles.
11050 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
11051 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
11052 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
11053 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
11054 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
11056 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
11057 some sort using the gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
11058 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
11059 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
11060 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
11064 @vindex nndraft-directory
11065 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
11066 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
11067 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
11068 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
11069 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
11070 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
11072 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
11073 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
11076 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
11077 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
11078 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
11079 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
11080 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
11081 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
11082 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
11083 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
11084 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
11085 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
11086 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
11087 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
11088 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
11089 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
11091 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
11092 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
11093 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
11095 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
11096 @kindex D e (Draft)
11097 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
11098 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
11099 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
11101 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
11104 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
11105 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
11106 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
11107 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
11108 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
11109 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
11110 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
11113 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
11114 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
11115 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
11118 @node Rejected Articles
11119 @section Rejected Articles
11120 @cindex rejected articles
11122 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
11123 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
11124 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
11125 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
11127 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of gnus.
11128 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
11129 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
11130 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So gnus saves these
11131 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
11133 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
11134 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
11135 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
11137 @node Signing and encrypting
11138 @section Signing and encrypting
11140 @cindex using s/mime
11141 @cindex using smime
11143 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla PGP
11144 format or @sc{pgp/mime} or @sc{s/mime}. For decoding such messages,
11145 see the @code{mm-verify-option} and @code{mm-decrypt-option} options
11146 (@pxref{Security}).
11148 For PGP, Gnus supports two external libraries, @sc{gpg.el} and
11149 @sc{Mailcrypt}, you need to install at least one of them. The
11150 @sc{s/mime} support in Gnus requires the external program OpenSSL.
11152 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
11153 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
11154 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
11155 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
11156 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
11157 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
11158 automatically encrypted messages.
11160 Instructing MML to perform security operations on a @sc{mime} part is
11161 done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for signing and the @kbd{C-c
11162 C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
11167 @kindex C-c C-m s s
11168 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
11170 Digitally sign current message using @sc{s/mime}.
11173 @kindex C-c C-m s o
11174 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
11176 Digitally sign current message using PGP.
11179 @kindex C-c C-m s p
11180 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
11182 Digitally sign current message using @sc{pgp/mime}.
11185 @kindex C-c C-m c s
11186 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
11188 Digitally encrypt current message using @sc{s/mime}.
11191 @kindex C-c C-m c o
11192 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
11194 Digitally encrypt current message using PGP.
11197 @kindex C-c C-m c p
11198 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
11200 Digitally encrypt current message using @sc{pgp/mime}.
11203 @kindex C-c C-m C-n
11204 @findex mml-unsecure-message
11205 Remove security related MML tags from message.
11209 Also @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}.
11211 @node Select Methods
11212 @chapter Select Methods
11213 @cindex foreign groups
11214 @cindex select methods
11216 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
11217 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
11218 @sc{nntp} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
11219 personal mail group.
11221 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
11222 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
11223 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
11224 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
11225 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
11226 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
11228 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
11229 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
11231 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
11234 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @sc{nntp} server
11235 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
11236 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
11237 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
11238 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
11240 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
11243 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
11244 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
11245 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
11246 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
11247 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
11248 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
11249 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
11250 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
11254 @node Server Buffer
11255 @section Server Buffer
11257 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
11258 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
11259 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
11260 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
11261 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
11262 back end represents a virtual server.
11264 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
11265 different actual @sc{nntp} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
11266 on the same actual @sc{nntp} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
11267 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
11269 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
11270 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
11271 @sc{nntp} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
11272 hangs if queried for @sc{nov} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
11273 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
11274 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
11275 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
11277 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
11278 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
11281 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
11282 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
11283 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
11284 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
11285 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
11286 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
11287 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
11290 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
11291 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
11294 @node Server Buffer Format
11295 @subsection Server Buffer Format
11296 @cindex server buffer format
11298 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
11299 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
11300 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
11301 variable, with some simple extensions:
11306 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
11309 The name of this server.
11312 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
11315 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
11318 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
11319 The mode line can also be customized by using the
11320 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
11321 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
11331 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
11334 @node Server Commands
11335 @subsection Server Commands
11336 @cindex server commands
11342 @findex gnus-server-add-server
11343 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
11347 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
11348 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
11351 @kindex SPACE (Server)
11352 @findex gnus-server-read-server
11353 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
11357 @findex gnus-server-exit
11358 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
11362 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
11363 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
11367 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
11368 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
11372 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
11373 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
11377 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
11378 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
11382 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
11383 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
11384 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
11389 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
11390 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
11391 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
11392 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
11397 @node Example Methods
11398 @subsection Example Methods
11400 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
11403 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
11406 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
11412 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
11413 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
11416 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
11417 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
11419 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
11420 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
11424 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
11427 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
11428 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
11430 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
11431 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
11432 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
11436 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
11439 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
11442 Here's the method for a public spool:
11446 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
11447 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
11453 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @sc{nntp}
11454 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
11455 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @sc{nntp} server.
11456 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
11457 should probably look something like this:
11461 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
11462 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
11463 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
11464 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
11467 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
11468 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
11469 configuration to the example above:
11472 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
11475 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
11477 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
11478 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
11479 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
11483 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
11484 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
11485 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
11486 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
11489 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
11490 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
11491 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
11492 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
11495 @node Creating a Virtual Server
11496 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
11498 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
11499 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
11501 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
11502 would probably be best to use @code{nnspool} to read the cache. You
11503 could also use @code{nnml} or @code{nnmh}, though.
11505 Type @kbd{a nnspool RET cache RET}.
11507 You should now have a brand new @code{nnspool} virtual server called
11508 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
11509 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
11510 will contain the following:
11520 (nnspool-spool-directory "~/News/cache/")
11521 (nnspool-nov-directory "~/News/cache/")
11522 (nnspool-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
11525 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
11526 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
11527 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
11530 @node Server Variables
11531 @subsection Server Variables
11533 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
11534 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
11535 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
11536 change the "base" variable after the variables have been loaded, you
11537 won't change the "derived" variables.
11539 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
11540 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
11541 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
11542 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
11543 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
11544 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
11545 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
11546 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
11547 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
11551 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
11552 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
11553 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
11557 @node Servers and Methods
11558 @subsection Servers and Methods
11560 Wherever you would normally use a select method
11561 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
11562 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
11563 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
11567 @node Unavailable Servers
11568 @subsection Unavailable Servers
11570 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
11571 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
11572 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
11573 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
11574 actually the case or not.
11576 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
11577 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
11578 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
11579 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
11580 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
11581 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
11582 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
11583 it will regard that server as ``down''.
11585 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
11586 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
11588 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
11589 with the following commands:
11595 @findex gnus-server-open-server
11596 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
11597 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
11601 @findex gnus-server-close-server
11602 Close the connection (if any) to the server
11603 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
11607 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
11608 Mark the current server as unreachable
11609 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
11612 @kindex M-o (Server)
11613 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
11614 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
11615 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
11618 @kindex M-c (Server)
11619 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
11620 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
11621 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
11625 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
11626 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
11627 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
11631 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
11632 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
11638 @section Getting News
11639 @cindex reading news
11640 @cindex news back ends
11642 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
11643 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @sc{nntp} server,
11644 or it can read from a local spool.
11647 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
11648 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
11656 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @sc{nntp} server is rather easy.
11657 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @sc{nntp}
11658 server as the, uhm, address.
11660 If the @sc{nntp} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
11661 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
11662 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
11663 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
11665 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
11666 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
11667 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
11669 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
11674 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
11675 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
11676 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
11678 @cindex authentification
11679 @cindex nntp authentification
11680 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
11681 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
11682 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
11683 commands to the @sc{nntp} server after it has been contacted. By
11684 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
11685 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
11686 present in this hook.
11688 @item nntp-authinfo-function
11689 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
11690 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
11691 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
11692 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @sc{nntp}
11693 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
11694 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
11695 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
11696 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
11697 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
11698 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
11699 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
11703 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
11706 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
11708 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
11709 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
11710 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
11711 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
11712 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
11713 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
11714 @samp{force} is explained below.
11718 Here's an example file:
11721 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
11722 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
11725 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
11726 have to be first, for instance.
11728 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
11729 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
11730 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
11731 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
11732 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
11733 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
11734 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
11736 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
11737 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
11743 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
11744 previously mentioned.
11746 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
11748 @item nntp-server-action-alist
11749 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
11750 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
11751 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
11752 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
11755 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
11756 '(("innd" (ding))))
11759 You probably don't want to do that, though.
11761 The default value is
11764 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
11765 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
11766 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
11769 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
11770 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
11772 @item nntp-maximum-request
11773 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
11774 If the @sc{nntp} server doesn't support @sc{nov} headers, this back end
11775 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
11776 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
11777 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
11778 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
11779 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
11781 @item nntp-connection-timeout
11782 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
11783 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
11784 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @sc{nntp} servers not
11785 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
11786 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
11787 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
11788 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
11789 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
11790 no timeouts are done.
11792 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
11793 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
11794 @c @cindex PPP connections
11795 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
11796 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
11797 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
11798 @c changes after connecting to the @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will simply sit
11799 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
11800 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
11801 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
11802 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
11803 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
11804 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
11806 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
11807 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
11808 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
11809 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
11810 @c described above.
11812 @item nntp-server-hook
11813 @vindex nntp-server-hook
11814 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @sc{nntp}
11817 @item nntp-buggy-select
11818 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
11819 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
11821 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
11822 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
11823 If the @sc{nntp} server does not support @sc{nov}, you could set this
11824 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @sc{nov}
11827 @item nntp-xover-commands
11828 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
11831 List of strings used as commands to fetch @sc{nov} lines from a
11832 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
11836 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
11837 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @sc{nov} lines to
11838 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
11839 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
11840 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @sc{nov}
11841 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
11842 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
11843 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
11844 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
11845 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
11846 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
11848 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
11849 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
11850 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @sc{nntp} server.
11852 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
11853 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
11854 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
11855 server closes connection.
11857 @item nntp-record-commands
11858 @vindex nntp-record-commands
11859 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
11860 @sc{nntp} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
11861 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@sc{nntp} connection
11862 that doesn't seem to work.
11864 @item nntp-open-connection-function
11865 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
11866 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
11867 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
11868 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
11869 Five pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
11870 two categories: direct connection functions (three pre-made), and
11871 indirect ones (two pre-made).
11873 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
11874 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
11875 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
11876 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
11877 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
11878 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
11879 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
11882 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
11885 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
11886 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
11888 @item nntp-list-options
11889 @vindex nntp-list-options
11890 List of newsgroup name used for a option of the LIST command to restrict
11891 the listing output to only the specified newsgroups. Each newsgroup name
11892 can be a shell-style wildcard, for instance, @dfn{fj.*}, @dfn{japan.*},
11893 etc. Fortunately, if the server can accept such a option, it will
11894 probably make gnus run faster. You may use it as a server variable as
11898 (setq gnus-select-method
11899 '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"
11900 (nntp-list-options ("fj.*" "japan.*"))))
11903 @item nntp-options-subscribe
11904 @vindex nntp-options-subscribe
11905 Regexp matching the newsgroup names which will be subscribed
11906 unconditionally. Use @dfn{ } instead of @dfn{$} for a regexp string.
11907 It may be effective as well as @code{nntp-list-options} even though the
11908 server could not accept a shell-style wildcard as a option of the LIST
11909 command. You may use it as a server variable as follows:
11912 (setq gnus-select-method
11913 '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"
11914 (nntp-options-subscribe "^fj\\.\\|^japan\\.")))
11917 @item nntp-options-not-subscribe
11918 @vindex nntp-options-not-subscribe
11919 Regexp matching the newsgroup names which will not be subscribed
11920 unconditionally. Use @dfn{ } instead of @dfn{$} for a regexp string.
11921 It may be effective as well as @code{nntp-list-options} even though the
11922 server could not accept a shell-style wildcard as a option of the LIST
11923 command. You may use it as a server variable as follows:
11926 (setq gnus-select-method
11927 '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"
11928 (nntp-options-not-subscribe "\\.binaries\\.")))
11933 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
11934 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
11935 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
11939 @node Direct Functions
11940 @subsubsection Direct Functions
11941 @cindex direct connection functions
11943 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
11944 between your machine and the @sc{nntp} server. The behavior of these
11945 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
11946 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
11949 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
11950 @item nntp-open-network-stream
11951 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
11954 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
11955 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
11956 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
11957 this you must have OpenSSL (@uref{http://www.openssl.org}) or SSLeay
11958 installed (@uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL}, and you also
11959 need @file{ssl.el} (from the W3 distribution, for instance). You then
11960 define a server as follows:
11963 ;; Type `C-c C-c' after you've finished editing.
11965 ;; "snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our /etc/services
11967 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
11968 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
11969 (nntp-port-number "snews")
11970 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
11973 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
11974 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
11975 Opens a connection to an @sc{nntp} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
11976 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
11977 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
11978 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
11979 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
11980 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
11984 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
11985 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
11986 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
11989 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
11990 session, which is not a good idea.
11994 @node Indirect Functions
11995 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
11996 @cindex indirect connection functions
11998 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
11999 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @sc{nntp} server.
12000 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12001 the "via" family of connection: they're all prefixed with "via" to make
12002 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12003 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12006 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12007 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12008 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12009 to the real @sc{nntp} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12010 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12012 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12015 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12016 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12017 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12018 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12020 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12021 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12022 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12023 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12024 @samp{ssh} for `nntp-via-rlogin-command', you may set this to
12025 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12026 this to @samp{("-t")} or @samp{("-C" "-t")} if the telnet command
12027 requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate host.
12030 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12031 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12032 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12033 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12035 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12038 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12039 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12040 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12043 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
12044 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
12045 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
12046 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
12048 @item nntp-via-user-password
12049 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
12050 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
12052 @item nntp-via-envuser
12053 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
12054 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
12055 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
12056 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
12058 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
12059 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
12060 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
12061 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
12068 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
12073 @item nntp-via-user-name
12074 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
12075 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
12077 @item nntp-via-address
12078 @vindex nntp-via-address
12079 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
12084 @node Common Variables
12085 @subsubsection Common Variables
12087 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
12088 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
12093 @item nntp-pre-command
12094 @vindex nntp-pre-command
12095 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native connection
12096 function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream} and
12097 @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}. This is where you would put a @samp{SOCKS}
12098 wrapper for instance.
12101 @vindex nntp-address
12102 The address of the @sc{nntp} server.
12104 @item nntp-port-number
12105 @vindex nntp-port-number
12106 Port number to connect to the @sc{nntp} server. The default is @samp{nntp}.
12108 @item nntp-end-of-line
12109 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
12110 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @sc{nntp}
12111 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
12112 using a non native connection function.
12114 @item nntp-telnet-command
12115 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
12116 Command to use when connecting to the @sc{nntp} server through
12117 @samp{telnet}. This is NOT for an intermediate host. This is just for
12118 the real @sc{nntp} server. The default is @samp{telnet}.
12120 @item nntp-telnet-switches
12121 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
12122 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
12129 @subsection News Spool
12133 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
12134 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
12135 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
12138 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
12139 anything else) as the address.
12141 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
12142 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
12143 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
12144 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
12148 @item nnspool-inews-program
12149 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
12150 Program used to post an article.
12152 @item nnspool-inews-switches
12153 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
12154 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
12156 @item nnspool-spool-directory
12157 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
12158 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
12159 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
12161 @item nnspool-nov-directory
12162 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
12163 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @sc{nov} files. This is normally
12164 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
12166 @item nnspool-lib-dir
12167 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
12168 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
12170 @item nnspool-active-file
12171 @vindex nnspool-active-file
12172 The path to the active file.
12174 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
12175 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
12176 The path to the group descriptions file.
12178 @item nnspool-history-file
12179 @vindex nnspool-history-file
12180 The path to the news history file.
12182 @item nnspool-active-times-file
12183 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
12184 The path to the active date file.
12186 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
12187 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
12188 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @sc{nov} files
12191 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
12192 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
12194 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
12195 relevant portion from the overview file. If nil, @code{nnspool} will
12196 load the entire file into a buffer and process it there.
12202 @section Getting Mail
12203 @cindex reading mail
12206 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
12210 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
12211 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
12212 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
12213 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
12214 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
12215 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
12216 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
12217 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
12218 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
12219 * Washing Mail:: Removing gruft from the mail you get.
12220 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
12221 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
12222 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
12226 @node Mail in a Newsreader
12227 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
12229 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
12230 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
12231 of a culture shock.
12233 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
12234 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
12236 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
12237 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
12238 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
12239 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
12241 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
12243 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
12244 deleted? How awful!
12246 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
12247 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
12248 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
12249 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @pxref{Expiring
12252 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
12253 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
12254 they want to treat a message.
12256 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
12257 via @sc{smtp}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
12258 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
12259 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
12260 archived somewhere else.
12262 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
12263 These are transported via @sc{nntp}, and are therefore news. But we may need
12264 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
12265 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
12266 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
12268 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
12269 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
12270 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
12272 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
12273 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
12276 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
12277 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
12278 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
12279 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
12280 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
12282 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
12283 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
12284 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
12285 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
12286 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
12287 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
12291 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
12292 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
12294 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
12295 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
12296 and things will happen automatically.
12298 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a "one file per
12299 mail" back end), you could put the following in your @file{.gnus} file:
12302 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
12305 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
12306 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
12307 directory, which is @code{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
12308 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
12309 like any other group.
12311 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
12314 (setq nnmail-split-methods
12315 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
12316 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
12320 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
12321 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
12322 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
12325 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
12326 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
12327 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
12330 @node Splitting Mail
12331 @subsection Splitting Mail
12332 @cindex splitting mail
12333 @cindex mail splitting
12335 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
12336 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
12337 to be split into groups.
12340 (setq nnmail-split-methods
12341 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
12342 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
12343 ("mail.other" "")))
12346 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
12347 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
12348 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
12349 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
12350 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
12351 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
12352 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
12355 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
12358 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
12359 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
12360 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
12361 mail belongs in that group.
12363 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
12364 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{} so that it matches any mails
12365 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
12366 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first
12367 rule to make a match will "win", unless you have crossposting enabled.
12368 In that case, all matching rules will "win".)
12370 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
12371 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
12372 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
12373 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
12374 thinks should carry this mail message.
12376 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
12377 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
12378 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
12379 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
12381 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
12382 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
12383 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
12384 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
12385 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{}) group.
12387 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
12390 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
12391 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
12392 links. If that's the case for you, set
12393 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
12394 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
12396 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
12397 @kindex nnmail-split-history
12398 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
12399 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
12400 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
12401 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
12404 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
12405 Header lines longer than the value of
12406 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
12409 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
12410 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
12411 By default the splitting codes MIME decodes headers so you can match
12412 on non-ASCII strings. The @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
12413 variable specifies the default charset for decoding. The behaviour
12414 can be turned off completely by binding
12415 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to nil, which is useful if you
12416 want to match articles based on the raw header data.
12418 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
12419 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
12420 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
12421 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
12422 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
12423 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
12424 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
12425 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
12426 month's rent money.
12430 @subsection Mail Sources
12432 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from a
12433 POP mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a maildir, for
12437 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
12438 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
12439 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
12443 @node Mail Source Specifiers
12444 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
12446 @cindex mail server
12449 @cindex mail source
12451 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
12452 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
12457 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
12460 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
12461 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
12462 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
12465 The following mail source types are available:
12469 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
12475 The path of the file. Defaults to the value of the @code{MAIL}
12476 environment variable or @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}.
12479 An example file mail source:
12482 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
12485 Or using the default path:
12491 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best to
12492 use POP or @sc{imap} or the like to fetch the mail. You can not use ange-ftp
12493 file names here---it has no way to lock the mail spool while moving the
12496 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
12500 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
12503 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
12507 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
12510 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
12512 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
12515 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
12519 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
12520 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
12521 That is, mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool} will be put in the
12522 group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix to be used instead
12523 of @code{.spool}.) Setting
12524 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-nil forces Gnus
12525 to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful if you
12526 want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
12532 The path of the directory where the files are. There is no default
12536 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
12540 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
12541 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
12542 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
12543 predicate are considered.
12547 Script run before/after fetching mail.
12551 An example directory mail source:
12554 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
12559 Get mail from a POP server.
12565 The name of the POP server. The default is taken from the
12566 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
12569 The port number of the POP server. This can be a number (eg,
12570 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
12571 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
12572 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
12573 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
12576 The user name to give to the POP server. The default is the login
12580 The password to give to the POP server. If not specified, the user is
12584 The program to use to fetch mail from the POP server. This should be
12585 a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
12588 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
12591 The valid format specifier characters are:
12595 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
12596 included in this string.
12599 The name of the server.
12602 The port number of the server.
12605 The user name to use.
12608 The password to use.
12611 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
12612 corresponding keywords.
12615 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
12616 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
12619 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
12620 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
12623 The function to use to fetch mail from the POP server. The function is
12624 called with one parameter---the name of the file where the mail should
12627 @item :authentication
12628 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
12629 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
12633 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this can be the symbol
12634 @code{ssl}, the symbol @code{tls} or others. The default is @code{nil}
12635 and use insecure connections. Note that for SSL/TLS, you need external
12636 programs and libraries:
12640 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through SSL@. Requires OpenSSL (the program
12641 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}) as well as the external
12642 library @samp{ssl.el}.
12644 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to SSL)@.
12645 Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
12650 Non-@code{nil} if mail is to be left on the server and UIDL used for
12651 message retrieval. The default is @code{nil}.
12655 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
12656 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
12658 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default POP server, using the
12659 default user name, and default fetcher:
12665 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
12668 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
12669 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
12672 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
12675 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
12679 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
12680 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
12681 contains exactly one mail.
12687 The path of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
12688 taken from the @code{MAILDIR} environment variable or
12691 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
12692 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
12694 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
12695 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
12696 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
12699 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
12700 from locking problems).
12704 Two example maildir mail sources:
12707 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
12708 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
12712 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
12717 Get mail from a @sc{imap} server. If you don't want to use @sc{imap}
12718 as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie with nnimap), for
12719 some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar to a POP server
12720 and fetches articles from a given @sc{imap} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for
12723 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, SSL/TLS and STARTTLS support you
12724 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
12730 The name of the @sc{imap} server. The default is taken from the
12731 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
12734 The port number of the @sc{imap} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
12735 @samp{993} for SSL/TLS connections.
12738 The user name to give to the @sc{imap} server. The default is the login
12742 The password to give to the @sc{imap} server. If not specified, the user is
12746 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
12747 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
12748 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{ssl},
12749 @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
12751 @item :authentication
12752 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
12753 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
12754 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
12755 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
12758 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
12759 mapped into the `imap-shell-program' variable. This should be a
12760 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
12766 The valid format specifier characters are:
12770 The name of the server.
12773 User name from `imap-default-user'.
12776 The port number of the server.
12779 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
12780 corresponding keywords.
12783 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
12784 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
12787 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
12788 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
12789 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @sc{imap} client and mark some
12790 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{nil}.
12791 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
12792 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
12795 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
12796 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
12797 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
12798 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
12801 If non-nil, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the mailbox
12802 after finishing the fetch.
12806 An example @sc{imap} mail source:
12809 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
12811 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
12815 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{www.hotmail.com},
12816 @uref{webmail.netscape.com}, @uref{www.netaddress.com},
12817 @uref{www.my-deja.com}.
12819 NOTE: Now @uref{mail.yahoo.com} provides POP3 service, so @sc{pop} mail source
12822 NOTE: Webmail largely depends cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
12823 required for url "4.0pre.46".
12825 WARNING: Mails may lost. NO WARRANTY.
12831 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
12832 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
12835 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
12839 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
12843 If non-nil, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to trash
12844 folder after finishing the fetch.
12848 An example webmail source:
12851 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
12853 :password "secret")
12858 @item Common Keywords
12859 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
12865 If non-nil, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you use
12866 directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this example:
12870 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
12875 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
12876 useful when you use local mail and news.
12881 @subsubsection Function Interface
12883 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
12884 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
12885 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
12886 consider the following mail-source setting:
12889 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
12890 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
12893 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
12894 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
12895 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
12896 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
12897 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
12899 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
12902 @node Mail Source Customization
12903 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
12905 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
12906 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
12910 @item mail-source-crash-box
12911 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
12912 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is
12913 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
12915 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
12916 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
12917 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them.
12919 @item mail-source-directory
12920 @vindex mail-source-directory
12921 Directory where files (if any) will be stored. The default is
12922 @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for is to say
12923 where the incoming files will be stored if the previous variable is
12926 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
12927 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
12928 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
12929 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
12930 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
12931 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
12933 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
12934 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
12935 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
12937 @item mail-source-movemail-program
12938 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
12939 If non-nil, name of program for fetching new mail. If nil,
12940 @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
12945 @node Fetching Mail
12946 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
12948 @vindex mail-sources
12949 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
12950 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
12951 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
12952 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
12954 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
12955 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
12958 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a POP
12959 mail server, you'd say something like:
12964 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12965 :password "secret")))
12968 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
12972 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
12973 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12976 :password "secret")))
12980 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
12981 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
12982 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
12983 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
12984 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
12985 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
12989 @node Mail Back End Variables
12990 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
12992 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
12996 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
12997 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
12998 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
12999 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13001 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13002 @item nnmail-split-hook
13003 @findex article-decode-encoded-words
13004 @findex RFC 1522 decoding
13005 @findex RFC 2047 decoding
13006 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
13007 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
13008 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
13009 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
13010 in the buffer will show up in any files.
13011 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
13014 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13015 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13016 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13017 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13018 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
13019 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
13020 starting to handle the new mail) and
13021 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
13022 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
13023 default file modes the new mail files get:
13026 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
13027 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
13029 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
13030 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
13033 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
13034 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
13035 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
13036 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
13037 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
13038 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
13039 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
13041 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
13042 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
13043 @findex delete-file
13044 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
13046 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13047 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13048 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
13049 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
13050 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
13052 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13053 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
13054 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
13055 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
13056 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
13058 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
13059 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
13060 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
13065 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
13066 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
13067 @cindex mail splitting
13068 @cindex fancy mail splitting
13070 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
13071 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
13072 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
13073 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
13074 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
13075 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
13077 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
13080 ;; Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of
13081 ;; the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group
13082 ;; from real errors.
13083 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
13085 ;; Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant
13086 ;; groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the
13087 ;; (ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.
13088 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
13089 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
13090 ;; Other mailing lists...
13091 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
13092 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
13093 ;; Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent
13094 ;; cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to
13095 ;; the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the
13096 ;; message was really cross-posted.
13097 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
13098 (any "mypackage@@somewhere\" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
13100 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
13101 ;; Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.
13105 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a (possibly)
13106 recursive structure where each split may contain other splits. Here are
13107 the five possible split syntaxes:
13112 @samp{group}: If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group
13113 name. Normal regexp match expansion will be done. See below for
13117 @code{(@var{field} @var{value} @code{[-} @var{restrict}
13118 @code{[@dots{}]}@code{]} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, the
13119 first element of which is a string, then store the message as
13120 specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field} (a regexp) contains
13121 @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp)
13122 matches some string after @var{field} and before the end of the
13123 matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If none of the
13124 @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
13127 @code{(| @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
13128 element is @code{|} (vertical bar), then process each @var{split} until
13129 one of them matches. A @var{split} is said to match if it will cause
13130 the mail message to be stored in one or more groups.
13133 @code{(& @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
13134 element is @code{&}, then process all @var{split}s in the list.
13137 @code{junk}: If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save
13138 (i.e., delete) this message. Use with extreme caution.
13141 @code{(: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})}: If the split is
13142 a list, and the first element is @code{:}, then the second element will
13143 be called as a function with @var{args} given as arguments. The
13144 function should return a @var{split}.
13147 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
13148 body of the messages:
13151 (defun split-on-body ()
13153 (set-buffer " *nnmail incoming*")
13154 (goto-char (point-min))
13155 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
13159 The @samp{" *nnmail incoming*"} is narrowed to the message in question
13160 when the @code{:} function is run.
13163 @code{(! @var{func} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, and the first
13164 element is @code{!}, then SPLIT will be processed, and FUNC will be
13165 called as a function with the result of SPLIT as argument. FUNC should
13169 @code{nil}: If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
13173 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
13174 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
13175 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
13176 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
13177 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
13179 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
13180 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be lisp symbols, in that case they
13181 are expanded as specified by the variable
13182 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells, where
13183 the @code{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @code{cdr} contains the associated
13186 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
13187 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
13188 when all this splitting is performed.
13190 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
13191 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
13192 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
13195 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
13198 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
13199 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
13201 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
13202 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
13203 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
13204 groupings 1 through 9.
13206 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
13207 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
13208 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
13209 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
13210 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
13211 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
13212 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
13213 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
13214 it once per thread.
13216 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} and
13217 @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-nil value. And then
13218 you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} using the colon
13221 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; or 'delete
13222 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
13224 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
13225 ;; other splits go here
13229 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
13230 non-nil, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees in the
13231 file specified by the variable @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file},
13232 together with the group it is in (the group is omitted for non-mail
13233 messages). When mail splitting is invoked, the function
13234 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks at the References (and
13235 In-Reply-To) header of each message to split and searches the file
13236 specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file} for the message ids.
13237 When it has found a parent, it returns the corresponding group name
13238 unless the group name matches the regexp
13239 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is recommended
13240 that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a somewhat higher
13241 number than the default so that the message ids are still in the cache.
13242 (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some 300 kBytes in size.)
13243 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
13244 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
13245 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
13246 messages goes into the new group.
13248 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
13249 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
13250 outgoing messages are written to an `outgoing' group, you could set
13251 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
13252 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
13256 @node Group Mail Splitting
13257 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
13258 @cindex mail splitting
13259 @cindex group mail splitting
13261 @findex gnus-group-split
13262 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
13263 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
13264 You just have to set @var{to-list} and/or @var{to-address} in group
13265 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
13266 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
13267 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
13268 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @var{to-list} or
13269 @var{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
13271 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
13272 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @var{extra-aliases} group
13273 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
13274 rather use a regular expression, set @var{split-regexp}.
13276 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
13277 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
13278 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
13279 @var{to-list}, @var{to-address}, all of @var{extra-aliases} and all
13280 matches of @var{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
13281 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
13282 @var{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
13284 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
13285 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
13286 parameter @var{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
13287 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
13288 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @var{split-spec} may be set to
13289 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
13290 @code{gnus-group-split}.
13292 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
13293 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
13294 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
13295 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
13296 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
13297 some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
13298 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
13299 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
13300 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
13301 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
13302 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
13303 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
13304 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
13306 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
13311 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
13312 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
13314 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
13315 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
13316 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
13317 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
13319 ((split-spec . catch-all))
13322 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
13323 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
13324 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
13327 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
13328 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
13329 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
13333 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
13334 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
13335 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
13339 (: gnus-group-split-fancy GROUPS NO-CROSSPOST CATCH-ALL)
13342 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
13343 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
13344 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
13345 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fallback
13346 fancy split, used like @var{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
13347 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @var{split-regexp} matches the
13348 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
13349 Otherwise, if some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
13350 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
13352 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
13353 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
13354 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
13355 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
13356 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
13357 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
13358 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
13359 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
13360 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
13362 @findex gnus-group-split-update
13363 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
13364 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
13365 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
13366 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
13367 you. For example, add to your @file{.gnus}:
13370 (gnus-group-split-setup AUTO-UPDATE CATCH-ALL)
13373 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
13374 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
13375 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
13376 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
13377 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
13380 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
13381 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
13382 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
13383 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
13385 @node Incorporating Old Mail
13386 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
13387 @cindex incorporating old mail
13388 @cindex import old mail
13390 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
13391 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
13392 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
13395 Doing so can be quite easy.
13397 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
13398 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
13399 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
13400 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
13401 your @code{nnml} groups.
13407 Go to the group buffer.
13410 Type `G f' and give the path to the mbox file when prompted to create an
13411 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13414 Type `SPACE' to enter the newly created group.
13417 Type `M P b' to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
13418 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
13421 Type `B r' to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
13422 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
13425 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
13426 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
13427 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
13428 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
13429 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
13431 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
13432 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
13433 using the new mail back end.
13436 @node Expiring Mail
13437 @subsection Expiring Mail
13438 @cindex article expiry
13440 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
13441 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
13442 different approach to mail reading.
13444 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
13445 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
13446 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
13447 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
13448 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
13449 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
13452 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
13453 articles as @dfn{expirable}. This does not mean that the articles will
13454 disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
13455 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
13456 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
13457 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
13458 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
13459 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
13461 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
13462 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Groups that
13463 match the regular expression @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will
13464 have all articles that you read marked as expirable automatically. All
13465 articles marked as expirable have an @samp{E} in the first
13466 column in the summary buffer.
13468 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
13469 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
13470 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
13471 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
13474 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
13476 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
13477 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
13478 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
13481 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
13482 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
13483 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
13484 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
13485 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
13487 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
13488 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
13491 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
13492 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
13495 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
13496 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
13498 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
13499 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
13500 don't really mix very well.
13502 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
13503 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
13504 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
13505 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
13508 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
13509 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
13510 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
13511 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
13514 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
13516 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
13518 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
13520 ((string= group "mail.junk")
13522 ((string= group "important")
13528 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
13529 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
13531 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
13532 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
13533 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
13536 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
13537 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
13539 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
13540 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
13541 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
13542 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
13543 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
13544 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
13545 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
13546 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
13547 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
13548 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
13549 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
13550 from as its parameter) which should return a target -- either a group
13551 name or @code{delete}.
13553 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
13555 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
13558 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
13559 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
13560 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
13561 expire mail to groups according to the variable
13562 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
13565 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
13566 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
13567 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
13568 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
13569 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
13572 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
13573 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
13574 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
13575 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
13576 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
13577 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
13579 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
13580 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
13581 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
13582 easier for procmail users.
13584 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
13585 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
13586 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
13587 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
13588 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
13589 caution. Even more dangerous is the
13590 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
13591 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
13592 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
13593 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
13594 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
13595 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
13596 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
13599 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
13601 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
13602 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
13603 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
13604 auto-expire turned on.
13608 @subsection Washing Mail
13609 @cindex mail washing
13610 @cindex list server brain damage
13611 @cindex incoming mail treatment
13613 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
13614 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
13615 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
13616 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
13617 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
13618 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
13620 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
13621 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
13622 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
13625 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
13626 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
13627 storing the mail to disc. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
13628 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
13631 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
13632 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
13633 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
13634 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
13635 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
13638 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
13639 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
13640 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
13641 Emacs running on MS machines.
13645 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
13646 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
13647 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
13648 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
13651 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
13652 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
13653 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
13654 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
13656 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
13657 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
13658 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
13659 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
13660 into a feature by documenting it.)
13662 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
13663 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
13664 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
13665 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
13666 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
13667 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
13668 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
13671 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
13672 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
13675 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
13676 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
13679 This can also be done non-destructively with
13680 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
13682 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
13683 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
13684 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
13686 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
13687 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
13689 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
13690 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
13691 @code{References} headers.
13695 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
13696 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
13697 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
13701 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
13702 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
13703 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
13710 @subsection Duplicates
13712 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
13713 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
13714 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
13715 @cindex duplicate mails
13716 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
13717 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
13718 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
13719 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
13720 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
13721 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
13722 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
13723 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
13724 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
13725 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
13726 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
13727 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
13728 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
13730 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
13731 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
13732 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
13733 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
13735 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
13738 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
13739 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
13743 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
13744 '(| ;; Messages duplicates go to a separate group.
13745 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
13746 ;; Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.
13747 (any mail "mail.misc")
13754 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13755 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
13760 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
13761 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
13762 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
13763 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
13764 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
13767 @node Not Reading Mail
13768 @subsection Not Reading Mail
13770 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
13771 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
13772 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
13774 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
13775 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
13776 mail, which should help.
13778 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
13779 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
13780 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
13781 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
13782 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
13783 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
13784 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old @sc{rmail}
13785 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
13786 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
13787 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
13788 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
13790 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
13791 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
13795 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
13796 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
13798 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
13799 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
13800 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
13802 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
13803 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
13804 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
13805 Spool}). You might notice that only five back ends are listed below;
13806 @code{nnmaildir}'s documentation has not yet been completely
13807 incorporated into this manual. Until it is, you can find it at
13808 @uref{http://multivac.cwru.edu./nnmaildir/}.
13811 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
13812 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
13813 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
13814 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
13815 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
13816 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
13820 @node Unix Mail Box
13821 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
13823 @cindex unix mail box
13825 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
13826 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
13827 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
13828 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
13829 which group it belongs in.
13831 Virtual server settings:
13834 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
13835 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
13836 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
13839 @item nnmbox-active-file
13840 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
13841 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
13842 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
13844 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
13845 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
13846 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
13847 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
13852 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
13856 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
13857 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
13858 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{rmail
13859 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
13860 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
13862 Virtual server settings:
13865 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
13866 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
13867 The name of the rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
13869 @item nnbabyl-active-file
13870 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
13871 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
13872 @file{~/.rmail-active}
13874 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
13875 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
13876 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
13882 @subsubsection Mail Spool
13884 @cindex mail @sc{nov} spool
13886 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
13887 format. It should be used with some caution.
13889 @vindex nnml-directory
13890 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
13891 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
13892 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
13893 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
13895 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
13898 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
13899 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
13900 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
13901 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
13902 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
13903 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
13904 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
13905 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
13907 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
13908 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
13909 @sc{nov} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
13910 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
13912 @cindex self contained nnml servers
13914 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
13915 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
13916 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
13917 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
13918 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
13919 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
13920 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
13921 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
13924 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
13925 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
13926 them next time it starts.
13928 Virtual server settings:
13931 @item nnml-directory
13932 @vindex nnml-directory
13933 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory.
13934 The default is the value of `message-directory' (whose default value is
13937 @item nnml-active-file
13938 @vindex nnml-active-file
13939 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
13940 @file{~/Mail/active"}.
13942 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
13943 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
13944 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
13945 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups"}.
13947 @item nnml-get-new-mail
13948 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
13949 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
13952 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
13953 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
13954 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{nov} files. The
13955 default is @code{nil}.
13957 @item nnml-nov-file-name
13958 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
13959 The name of the @sc{nov} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
13961 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
13962 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
13963 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
13965 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
13966 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
13967 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
13968 default is @code{nil}.
13970 @item nnml-marks-file-name
13971 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
13972 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
13974 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
13975 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
13976 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
13981 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
13982 If your @code{nnml} groups and @sc{nov} files get totally out of whack,
13983 you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
13984 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
13985 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
13986 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
13987 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
13992 @subsubsection MH Spool
13994 @cindex mh-e mail spool
13996 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
13997 @sc{nov} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks file.
13998 This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than @code{nnml},
13999 but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts for.
14001 Virtual server settings:
14004 @item nnmh-directory
14005 @vindex nnmh-directory
14006 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
14007 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14010 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
14011 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14012 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
14016 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
14017 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
14018 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks they
14019 are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
14020 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
14021 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not have
14022 to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
14027 @subsubsection Mail Folders
14029 @cindex mbox folders
14030 @cindex mail folders
14032 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a separate
14033 file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format. @code{nnfolder}
14034 will add extra headers to keep track of article numbers and arrival
14037 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
14039 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
14040 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
14041 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
14042 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
14043 Marks for a group is usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
14044 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
14045 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder} directory.
14046 Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to backup, use
14047 @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the
14048 @code{nnfolder} directory).
14050 Virtual server settings:
14053 @item nnfolder-directory
14054 @vindex nnfolder-directory
14055 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this directory.
14056 The default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
14059 @item nnfolder-active-file
14060 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
14061 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
14063 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
14064 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
14065 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
14066 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups"}
14068 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
14069 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14070 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The default
14073 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
14074 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
14075 @cindex backup files
14076 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
14077 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If you
14078 wish to switch this off, you could say something like the following in
14079 your @file{.emacs} file:
14082 (defun turn-off-backup ()
14083 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
14085 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
14088 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
14089 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
14090 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
14091 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
14092 extract some information from it before removing it.
14094 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
14095 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
14096 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{nov} files. The
14097 default is @code{nil}.
14099 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
14100 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
14101 The extension for @sc{nov} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
14103 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
14104 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
14105 The directory where the @sc{nov} files should be stored. If nil,
14106 @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
14108 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
14109 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
14110 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
14111 default is @code{nil}.
14113 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
14114 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
14115 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
14117 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
14118 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
14119 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If nil,
14120 @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
14125 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
14126 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
14127 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
14128 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
14129 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
14130 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
14133 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
14134 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
14136 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
14137 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
14138 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
14139 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
14140 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
14142 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
14143 typically done by @sc{nntp} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
14144 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
14145 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @sc{nntp} server), and
14146 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
14147 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
14148 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
14149 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
14152 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
14153 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
14154 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
14155 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
14160 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
14161 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
14162 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
14163 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
14164 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
14165 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
14166 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
14167 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
14168 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
14169 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
14170 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
14171 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
14172 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
14177 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
14178 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
14179 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
14180 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
14181 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
14182 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
14183 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
14184 RMAIL was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
14185 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote RMAIL
14186 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
14187 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
14188 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
14189 headers/status bits stuff. RMAIL itself still exists as well, of
14190 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
14192 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
14193 filesystem, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
14198 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
14199 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
14200 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
14201 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
14202 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
14203 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
14204 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
14205 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
14206 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
14207 @sc{nntp} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
14208 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
14209 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
14210 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
14211 provided by the active file and overviews.
14213 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
14214 resource which defines available places in the filesystem to put new
14215 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
14216 tight, shared filesystems. But if you live on a personal machine where
14217 the filesystem is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
14220 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
14221 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
14226 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
14227 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
14228 individual files, but with little or no indexing support -- @code{nnmh}
14229 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
14230 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
14231 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
14232 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
14236 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
14237 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
14238 itself puts *all* one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
14239 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
14240 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
14241 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
14242 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
14243 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
14244 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
14246 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
14247 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
14248 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
14249 friendly mail back end all over.
14253 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
14254 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
14255 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
14256 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
14257 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
14258 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
14259 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to ReiserFS
14260 (@uref{http://www.namesys.com/}) or another non-block-structured
14263 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
14264 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
14265 This means you can skip Gnus's mail splitting if your mail is already
14266 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
14267 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
14268 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
14269 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
14270 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
14271 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
14272 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will undergo
14273 treatment such as duplicate checking.
14275 An article will not necessarily keep the same number across Gnus
14276 sessions; articles are renumbered starting from 1 for each Gnus session
14277 (more precisely, each time you open the @code{nnmaildir} server). This
14278 way, you don't get gaps in your article number ranges, and when entering
14279 large groups, Gnus is likely to give a more accurate article count. The
14280 price is that @code{nnmaildir} doesn't work with the cache or agent.
14281 This will probably be changed in the future.
14283 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
14284 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
14285 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
14286 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
14287 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
14290 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses group
14291 parameters slightly different from those of other mail backends.
14293 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
14294 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
14295 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
14296 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
14297 parameter to somthing small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
14298 would) to make it use less memory.
14300 Startup and shutdown are likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than
14301 with other backends. Everything in between is likely to be faster,
14302 depending in part on your filesystem.
14304 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
14305 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived backend.
14310 @node Browsing the Web
14311 @section Browsing the Web
14313 @cindex browsing the web
14317 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
14318 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
14319 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
14320 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
14321 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
14322 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
14323 even know what a news group is.
14325 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
14326 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
14327 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
14328 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
14329 you mad in the end.
14331 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
14334 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
14335 interfaces to these sources.
14339 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
14340 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
14341 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
14342 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
14343 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
14344 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
14347 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
14349 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
14350 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @sc{html} data
14351 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
14352 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
14353 though, you should be ok.
14355 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
14356 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
14357 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
14358 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
14359 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
14361 @node Archiving Mail
14362 @subsection Archiving Mail
14363 @cindex archiving mail
14364 @cindex backup of mail
14366 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
14367 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
14368 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
14369 marks is fairly simple.
14371 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
14372 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
14375 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
14376 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
14377 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
14378 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
14379 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
14380 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
14381 might interfer with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
14382 before you restore the data.
14384 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
14385 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
14386 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
14387 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
14388 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
14389 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
14390 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
14391 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
14392 is unnecessary in that case.
14395 @subsection Web Searches
14400 @cindex InReference
14401 @cindex Usenet searches
14402 @cindex searching the Usenet
14404 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
14405 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
14406 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
14407 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
14408 searches without having to use a browser.
14410 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
14411 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
14412 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
14413 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
14414 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
14416 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
14417 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
14418 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
14419 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
14420 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
14421 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
14422 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
14423 engines (DejaNews, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
14424 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
14425 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
14428 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
14429 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
14430 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
14431 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
14432 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
14433 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
14435 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
14436 to use @code{nnweb}.
14438 Virtual server variables:
14443 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
14444 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, @code{altavista} and
14448 @vindex nnweb-search
14449 The search string to feed to the search engine.
14451 @item nnweb-max-hits
14452 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
14453 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
14456 @item nnweb-type-definition
14457 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
14458 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
14459 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
14464 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
14468 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
14471 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
14474 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
14478 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
14485 @subsection Slashdot
14489 Slashdot (@uref{http://slashdot.org/}) is a popular news site, with
14490 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
14491 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
14493 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
14494 following in your @file{.gnus.el} file:
14497 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
14498 '((nnslashdot "")))
14501 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
14502 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
14503 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
14504 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
14505 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
14508 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
14509 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14511 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
14512 comments), some light @sc{html}izations will be performed. In
14513 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
14514 @code{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @code{br} added to
14515 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @sc{html}
14516 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
14519 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
14522 @item nnslashdot-threaded
14523 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
14524 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
14525 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
14526 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
14527 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
14528 but much, much slower than untreaded.
14530 @item nnslashdot-login-name
14531 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
14532 The login name to use when posting.
14534 @item nnslashdot-password
14535 @vindex nnslashdot-password
14536 The password to use when posting.
14538 @item nnslashdot-directory
14539 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
14540 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
14541 @samp{~/News/slashdot/}.
14543 @item nnslashdot-active-url
14544 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
14545 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the information on
14546 news articles and comments. The default is
14547 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
14549 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
14550 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
14551 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch comments. The
14553 @samp{http://slashdot.org/comments.pl?sid=%s&threshold=%d&commentsort=%d&mode=flat&startat=%d}.
14555 @item nnslashdot-article-url
14556 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
14557 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the news article. The
14559 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
14561 @item nnslashdot-threshold
14562 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
14563 The score threshold. The default is -1.
14565 @item nnslashdot-group-number
14566 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
14567 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
14568 updated. The default is 0.
14575 @subsection Ultimate
14577 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
14579 The Ultimate Bulletin Board (@uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/}) is
14580 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
14581 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
14582 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
14584 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
14585 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
14586 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @sc{url}
14587 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
14588 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
14589 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
14590 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
14592 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
14595 @item nnultimate-directory
14596 @vindex nnultimate-directory
14597 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is
14598 @samp{~/News/ultimate/}.
14603 @subsection Web Archive
14605 @cindex Web Archive
14607 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
14608 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
14609 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
14610 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
14613 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
14614 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
14615 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET an_egroup RET egroups RET
14616 www.egroups.com RET your@@email.address RET}. (Substitute the
14617 @sc{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
14618 @sc{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
14619 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
14621 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
14624 @item nnwarchive-directory
14625 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
14626 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is
14627 @samp{~/News/warchive/}.
14629 @item nnwarchive-login
14630 @vindex nnwarchive-login
14631 The account name on the web server.
14633 @item nnwarchive-passwd
14634 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
14635 The password for your account on the web server.
14643 Some sites have RDF site summary (RSS)
14644 @uref{http://purl.org/rss/1.0/spec}. It has a quite regular and nice
14645 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
14648 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something
14649 like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET}, then
14652 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
14655 @item nnrss-directory
14656 @vindex nnrss-directory
14657 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
14658 @samp{~/News/rss/}.
14662 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
14663 the summary buffer.
14666 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
14667 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
14669 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
14671 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
14672 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
14675 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
14678 (require 'browse-url)
14680 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
14682 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
14685 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
14686 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
14688 (browse-url (cdr url))
14689 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
14691 (eval-after-load "gnus"
14692 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
14693 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
14694 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
14697 @node Customizing w3
14698 @subsection Customizing w3
14704 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
14705 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
14706 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
14708 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
14709 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
14710 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
14713 (eval-after-load "w3"
14715 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
14716 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
14717 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
14718 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
14720 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
14723 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
14724 @sc{html} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
14733 @sc{imap} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or ...),
14734 think of it as a modernized @sc{nntp}. Connecting to a @sc{imap}
14735 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
14736 specify the network address of the server.
14738 @sc{imap} has two properties. First, @sc{imap} can do everything that
14739 POP can, it can hence be viewed as a POP++. Secondly, @sc{imap} is a
14740 mail storage protocol, similar to @sc{nntp} being a news storage
14741 protocol -- however, @sc{imap} offers more features than @sc{nntp}
14742 because news is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
14744 If you want to use @sc{imap} as a POP++, use an imap entry in
14745 @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from the
14746 @sc{imap} server and store them on the local disk. This is not the
14747 usage described in this section--@xref{Mail Sources}.
14749 If you want to use @sc{imap} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
14750 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
14751 manipulate mails stored on the @sc{imap} server. This is the kind of
14752 usage explained in this section.
14754 A server configuration in @code{~/.gnus} with a few @sc{imap} servers
14755 might look something like the following. (Note that for SSL/TLS, you
14756 need external programs and libraries, see below.)
14759 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
14760 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; no special configuration
14761 ; perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:
14763 (nnimap-address "localhost")
14764 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
14765 ; a UW server running on localhost
14767 (nnimap-server-port 143)
14768 (nnimap-address "localhost")
14769 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
14770 ; anonymous public cyrus server:
14771 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
14772 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
14773 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
14774 (nnimap-stream network))
14775 ; a ssl server on a non-standard port:
14777 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
14778 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
14779 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
14782 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
14787 @item nnimap-address
14788 @vindex nnimap-address
14790 The address of the remote @sc{imap} server. Defaults to the virtual
14791 server name if not specified.
14793 @item nnimap-server-port
14794 @vindex nnimap-server-port
14795 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for SSL.
14797 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
14800 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
14801 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
14804 @item nnimap-list-pattern
14805 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
14806 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
14807 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
14808 interested in a few -- some servers export your home directory via
14809 @sc{imap}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
14810 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
14812 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
14813 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
14814 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
14817 Example server specification:
14820 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
14821 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
14822 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
14825 @item nnimap-stream
14826 @vindex nnimap-stream
14827 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
14828 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
14829 of SSL/TLS. (@sc{imap} over SSL/TLS is being replaced by STARTTLS, which
14830 can be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
14832 Example server specification:
14835 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
14836 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14839 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
14843 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
14844 @samp{imtest} program.
14846 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
14848 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
14849 SSL). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
14852 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through SSL. Requires OpenSSL (the program
14853 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}) as well as the external
14854 library @samp{ssl.el}.
14856 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @sc{imap} connection.
14858 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
14861 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
14862 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
14863 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
14864 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
14865 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
14866 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
14867 restrictions on @sc{imap} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
14868 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
14869 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
14872 @vindex imap-ssl-program
14873 For SSL connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
14874 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
14875 and nnimap support it too - altough the most recent versions of
14876 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
14877 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
14878 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
14879 to OpenSSL/SSLeay. You also need @samp{ssl.el} (from the W3
14880 distribution, for instance).
14882 @vindex imap-shell-program
14883 @vindex imap-shell-host
14884 For @sc{imap} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
14885 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
14887 @item nnimap-authenticator
14888 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
14890 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
14891 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
14893 Example server specification:
14896 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
14897 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
14900 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
14904 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
14905 external program @code{imtest}.
14907 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
14910 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
14911 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
14913 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
14915 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
14917 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as `anonymous', supplying your emailadress as password.
14920 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
14922 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
14923 Unlike Parmenides the @sc{imap} designers has decided that things that
14924 doesn't exist actually does exist. More specifically, @sc{imap} has
14925 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
14926 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
14927 nnimap does when you delete a article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
14930 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
14931 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
14932 running in circles yet?
14934 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
14935 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
14938 The possible options are:
14943 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as "Deleted" when
14946 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
14947 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @sc{imap} clients
14948 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
14949 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
14951 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
14956 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
14957 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
14959 If non-nil (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as well),
14960 for other @sc{imap} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
14961 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
14962 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @sc{imap}
14963 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @sc{imap}
14966 Probably the only reason for frobing this would be if you're trying
14967 enable per-user persistant dormant flags, using something like:
14970 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
14971 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
14972 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
14973 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
14976 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
14977 as ticked for other users.
14979 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
14981 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
14983 This variable contain the @sc{imap} search command sent to server when
14984 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
14985 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
14986 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
14988 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
14989 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
14990 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
14991 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
14993 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
14994 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
14996 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
14997 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
14998 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
15004 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
15005 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
15006 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
15011 @node Splitting in IMAP
15012 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
15013 @cindex splitting imap mail
15015 Splitting is something Gnus users has loved and used for years, and now
15016 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
15017 @sc{imap} server has server side splitting and those that have splitting
15018 seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that @sc{imap}
15019 support for Gnus has to do it's own splitting.
15023 Here are the variables of interest:
15027 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
15028 @cindex splitting, crosspost
15030 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
15032 If non-nil, do crossposting if several split methods match the mail. If
15033 nil, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule} found will be used.
15035 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
15037 @item nnimap-split-inbox
15038 @cindex splitting, inbox
15040 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
15042 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @sc{imap}
15043 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to nil, which means that splitting is
15047 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
15048 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
15051 No nnmail equivalent.
15053 @item nnimap-split-rule
15054 @cindex Splitting, rules
15055 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
15057 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
15060 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
15061 sublist gives the name of the @sc{imap} mailbox to move articles
15062 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
15063 Neither did I, we need examples.
15066 (setq nnimap-split-rule
15068 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
15069 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
15070 ("INBOX.private" "")))
15073 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
15074 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
15075 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
15077 The first string may contain `\\1' forms, like the ones used by
15078 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
15082 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
15085 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
15086 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
15087 containing the headers of the article. It should return a non-nil value
15088 if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
15090 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
15091 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
15092 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
15093 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
15094 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
15095 them every time you fetch new mail.)
15097 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
15098 end. The first rule to make a match will "win", unless you have
15099 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will "win".
15101 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
15102 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
15103 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
15105 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
15107 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
15108 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
15109 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
15112 (setq nnimap-split-rule
15113 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
15114 ("junk" "From:.*Simon")))
15115 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
15116 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
15117 ("junk" my-junk-func)))))
15120 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
15121 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
15122 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
15123 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
15124 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
15125 group/function elements.
15127 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
15129 @item nnimap-split-predicate
15131 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
15133 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
15134 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
15136 This might be useful if you use another @sc{imap} client to read mail in
15137 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
15138 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
15141 @item nnimap-split-fancy
15142 @cindex splitting, fancy
15143 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
15144 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
15146 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
15147 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
15148 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
15150 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
15151 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
15152 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
15153 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
15158 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
15159 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
15162 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
15166 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
15167 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
15168 @cindex editing imap acls
15169 @cindex Access Control Lists
15170 @cindex Editing @sc{imap} ACLs
15172 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
15174 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @sc{imap} for
15175 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
15176 @sc{imap} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
15179 To edit a ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
15180 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with a ACL
15181 editing window with detailed instructions.
15183 Some possible uses:
15187 Giving "anyone" the "lrs" rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
15188 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
15189 follow the list without subscribing to it.
15191 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
15192 "anyone" posting ("p") capabilities to have "plussing" work (that is,
15193 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @sc{imap} mailbox
15197 @node Expunging mailboxes
15198 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
15202 @cindex Manual expunging
15204 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
15206 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
15207 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
15208 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
15210 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
15215 @node Other Sources
15216 @section Other Sources
15218 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
15219 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
15223 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
15224 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
15225 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
15226 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
15227 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
15231 @node Directory Groups
15232 @subsection Directory Groups
15234 @cindex directory groups
15236 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
15237 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
15240 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
15241 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
15242 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
15243 back end to read directories. Big deal.
15245 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
15246 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
15247 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
15248 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
15249 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
15251 @code{nndir} will use @sc{nov} files if they are present.
15253 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
15254 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
15255 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
15256 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
15259 @node Anything Groups
15260 @subsection Anything Groups
15263 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
15264 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
15265 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
15268 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
15269 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
15270 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
15271 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
15272 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
15273 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
15274 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
15275 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
15276 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
15277 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
15280 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
15281 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
15282 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
15283 in the article buffer, just as usual.
15285 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
15286 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
15287 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
15288 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
15290 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
15291 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
15292 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
15293 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
15294 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
15295 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
15296 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
15297 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
15302 @item nneething-map-file-directory
15303 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
15304 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
15305 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
15307 @item nneething-exclude-files
15308 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
15309 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
15310 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
15312 @item nneething-include-files
15313 @vindex nneething-include-files
15314 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
15315 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
15317 @item nneething-map-file
15318 @vindex nneething-map-file
15319 Name of the map files.
15323 @node Document Groups
15324 @subsection Document Groups
15326 @cindex documentation group
15329 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
15330 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
15337 The babyl (rmail) mail box.
15342 The standard Unix mbox file.
15344 @cindex MMDF mail box
15346 The MMDF mail box format.
15349 Several news articles appended into a file.
15352 @cindex rnews batch files
15353 The rnews batch transport format.
15354 @cindex forwarded messages
15357 Forwarded articles.
15360 Netscape mail boxes.
15363 @sc{mime} multipart messages.
15365 @item standard-digest
15366 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
15369 A @sc{mime} digest of messages.
15371 @item lanl-gov-announce
15372 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
15374 @item rfc822-forward
15375 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
15378 The Outlook mail box.
15381 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
15384 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
15387 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
15390 An RFC934-forwarded message.
15396 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
15399 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
15405 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
15406 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
15407 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
15410 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
15411 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
15412 group. And that's it.
15414 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
15415 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
15416 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
15417 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
15418 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
15419 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
15420 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
15421 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
15422 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
15423 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
15425 Virtual server variables:
15428 @item nndoc-article-type
15429 @vindex nndoc-article-type
15430 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
15431 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
15432 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
15433 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
15434 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
15436 @item nndoc-post-type
15437 @vindex nndoc-post-type
15438 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
15439 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
15444 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
15448 @node Document Server Internals
15449 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
15451 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
15452 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
15453 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
15454 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
15456 First, here's an example document type definition:
15460 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
15461 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
15464 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
15465 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
15466 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
15467 types can be defined with very few settings:
15470 @item first-article
15471 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
15472 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
15475 @item article-begin
15476 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
15477 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
15479 @item head-begin-function
15480 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
15483 @item nndoc-head-begin
15484 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
15487 @item nndoc-head-end
15488 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
15489 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
15491 @item body-begin-function
15492 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
15496 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
15499 @item body-end-function
15500 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
15504 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
15507 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
15508 regexp will be totally ignored.
15512 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
15513 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
15514 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
15515 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
15516 something that's palatable for Gnus:
15519 @item prepare-body-function
15520 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
15521 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
15522 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
15524 @item article-transform-function
15525 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
15526 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
15527 body of the article.
15529 @item generate-head-function
15530 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
15531 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
15532 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
15533 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
15537 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
15542 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
15543 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
15544 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
15545 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
15546 (head-end . "^ ?$")
15547 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
15548 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
15549 (subtype digest guess))
15552 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
15553 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
15554 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
15555 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
15556 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
15558 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
15559 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first is
15560 the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says where in
15561 the document type definition alist to put this definition. The alist is
15562 traversed sequentially, and @code{nndoc-TYPE-type-p} is called for a given type @code{TYPE}. So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document
15563 is of @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
15564 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it is
15565 of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
15566 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number means
15567 low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
15575 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
15576 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
15577 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
15579 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
15580 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
15581 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
15584 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
15585 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
15586 that interested in doing things properly.
15588 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
15589 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
15592 First some terminology:
15597 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
15598 get news and/or mail from.
15601 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
15602 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
15605 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
15609 @item message packets
15610 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
15611 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
15612 default, where @var{x} is a number.
15614 @item response packets
15615 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
15616 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
15617 default, where @var{x} is a number.
15627 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
15628 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
15629 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
15630 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
15633 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
15636 You put the packet in your home directory.
15639 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
15640 the native or secondary server.
15643 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
15644 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
15647 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
15651 You transfer this packet to the server.
15654 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
15657 You then repeat until you die.
15661 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
15662 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
15665 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
15666 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
15667 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
15671 @node SOUP Commands
15672 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
15674 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
15678 @kindex G s b (Group)
15679 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
15680 Pack all unread articles in the current group
15681 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
15682 process/prefix convention.
15685 @kindex G s w (Group)
15686 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
15687 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
15690 @kindex G s s (Group)
15691 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
15692 Send all replies from the replies packet
15693 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
15696 @kindex G s p (Group)
15697 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
15698 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
15701 @kindex G s r (Group)
15702 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
15703 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
15706 @kindex O s (Summary)
15707 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
15708 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
15709 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
15710 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
15715 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
15720 @item gnus-soup-directory
15721 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
15722 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
15723 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
15725 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
15726 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
15727 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
15728 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
15730 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
15731 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
15732 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
15733 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
15735 @item gnus-soup-packer
15736 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
15737 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
15738 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
15740 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
15741 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
15742 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
15743 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
15745 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
15746 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
15747 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
15749 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
15750 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
15751 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
15752 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
15758 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
15761 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
15762 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
15763 you can read them at leisure.
15765 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
15769 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
15770 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
15771 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
15772 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
15774 @item nnsoup-directory
15775 @vindex nnsoup-directory
15776 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
15777 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
15779 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
15780 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
15781 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
15782 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/"}.
15784 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
15785 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
15786 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
15787 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
15788 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
15790 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
15791 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
15792 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
15793 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
15795 @item nnsoup-active-file
15796 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
15797 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
15798 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
15799 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
15800 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
15802 @item nnsoup-packer
15803 @vindex nnsoup-packer
15804 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
15805 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
15807 @item nnsoup-unpacker
15808 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
15809 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
15810 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
15812 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
15813 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
15814 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
15817 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
15818 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
15819 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
15822 @item nnsoup-always-save
15823 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
15824 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
15830 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
15832 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
15833 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
15834 more for that to happen.
15836 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
15837 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
15838 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
15841 In specific, this is what it does:
15844 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
15845 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
15848 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
15849 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
15850 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
15853 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
15854 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
15855 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
15858 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
15859 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
15860 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
15862 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
15868 @item nngateway-address
15869 @vindex nngateway-address
15870 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
15872 @item nngateway-header-transformation
15873 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
15874 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
15875 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
15876 transformation should be called, and defaults to
15877 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
15878 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
15881 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
15882 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
15883 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
15886 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
15889 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
15892 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
15895 The following pre-defined functions exist:
15897 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
15900 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
15901 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
15902 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
15904 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
15906 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
15907 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
15908 @code{nngateway-address}.
15913 (setq gnus-post-method
15915 "mail2news@@replay.com"
15916 (nngateway-header-transformation
15917 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
15925 So, to use this, simply say something like:
15928 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
15933 @node Combined Groups
15934 @section Combined Groups
15936 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
15940 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
15941 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
15945 @node Virtual Groups
15946 @subsection Virtual Groups
15948 @cindex virtual groups
15949 @cindex merging groups
15951 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
15954 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
15955 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
15956 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
15958 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
15959 regexp to match component groups.
15961 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
15962 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
15963 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
15964 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
15965 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
15966 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
15967 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
15968 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
15970 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
15971 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
15974 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
15977 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
15978 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
15980 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
15981 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
15982 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
15983 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
15986 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
15989 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
15990 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
15991 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
15993 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
15994 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
15995 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
15996 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
15997 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
15999 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
16000 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
16001 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
16003 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
16004 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
16005 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
16006 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
16007 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
16008 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
16009 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
16010 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
16011 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
16012 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
16013 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
16015 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
16016 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
16017 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
16018 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
16019 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
16020 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
16021 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
16023 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
16024 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
16026 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
16027 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
16031 @node Kibozed Groups
16032 @subsection Kibozed Groups
16036 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by @sc{oed} as ``grepping through (parts of)
16037 the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will do this for
16038 you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @sc{nntp} server down to a halt
16039 with useless requests! Oh happiness!
16041 @kindex G k (Group)
16042 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
16045 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
16046 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
16047 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between @code{nnkiboze}
16048 and @code{nnvirtual} end.
16050 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an @code{nnkiboze} group
16051 must have a score file to say what articles are to be included in
16052 the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
16054 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
16055 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
16056 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
16057 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time. Lots of
16058 time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the headers from
16059 all the articles in all the component groups and run them through the
16060 scoring process to determine if there are any articles in the groups
16061 that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
16063 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
16064 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
16065 @sc{nntp} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
16066 Stranger things have happened.
16068 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
16069 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
16071 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
16072 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
16073 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/} by default. One
16074 contains the @sc{nov} header lines for all the articles in the group,
16075 and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store information
16076 on what groups have been searched through to find component articles.
16078 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
16079 their @sc{nov} lines removed from the @sc{nov} file.
16082 @node Gnus Unplugged
16083 @section Gnus Unplugged
16088 @cindex Gnus Unplugged
16090 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
16091 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
16092 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
16093 read news. Believe it or not.
16095 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
16096 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
16097 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
16098 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
16099 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
16101 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
16102 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
16103 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
16104 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
16105 reading news on a machine.
16107 Using Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple.
16111 First, set up Gnus as you would do if you were running it on a machine
16112 that has full connection to the net. Go ahead. I'll still be waiting
16116 Then, put the following magical incantation in your @file{.gnus.el}
16120 (setq gnus-agent t)
16124 That's it. Gnus is now an ``offline'' newsreader.
16126 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
16129 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
16130 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
16131 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
16132 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
16133 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
16134 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
16135 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
16136 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
16137 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
16138 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
16143 @subsection Agent Basics
16145 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
16147 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
16148 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
16149 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
16150 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
16152 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
16153 connected to the net continuously.
16155 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
16156 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
16158 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
16163 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
16164 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
16165 already fetched while in this mode.
16168 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
16169 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
16170 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
16171 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode, see (@pxref{Mail
16172 Source Specifiers}).
16175 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the news
16176 onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press @kbd{g}
16177 to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J
16178 s} to fetch all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus
16179 know which articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}.)
16182 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
16183 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
16184 then you read the news offline.
16187 And then you go to step 2.
16190 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
16196 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
16197 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
16198 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
16199 @kbd{J a} the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
16200 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}). This will typically be only the
16201 primary select method, which is listed on the bottom in the buffer.
16204 Decide on download policy. @xref{Agent Categories}.
16211 @node Agent Categories
16212 @subsection Agent Categories
16214 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
16215 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
16216 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
16217 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
16218 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
16219 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
16220 you're interested in the articles anyway.
16222 The main way to control what is to be downloaded is to create a
16223 @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all) groups to this category.
16224 Groups that do not belong in any other category belong to the
16225 @code{default} category. Gnus has its own buffer for creating and
16226 managing categories.
16229 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
16230 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
16231 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
16235 @node Category Syntax
16236 @subsubsection Category Syntax
16238 A category consists of two things.
16242 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
16243 are eligible for downloading; and
16246 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
16247 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
16248 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
16251 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
16252 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
16253 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
16254 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
16256 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
16257 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
16258 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
16260 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
16261 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
16262 operators sprinkled in between.
16264 Perhaps some examples are in order.
16266 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
16267 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
16273 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
16274 short (for some value of ``short'').
16276 Here's a more complex predicate:
16285 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
16286 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
16289 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
16290 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
16291 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
16293 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
16294 you want to do, you can write your own.
16298 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
16299 lines; default 100.
16302 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
16303 lines; default 200.
16306 True iff the article has a download score less than
16307 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
16310 True iff the article has a download score greater than
16311 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
16314 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
16315 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
16316 checksum and sees whether articles match.
16325 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
16326 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
16327 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
16330 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
16331 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
16332 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
16333 something along the lines of the following:
16336 (defun my-article-old-p ()
16337 "Say whether an article is old."
16338 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
16339 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
16342 with the predicate then defined as:
16345 (not my-article-old-p)
16348 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
16349 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
16353 (require 'gnus-agent)
16354 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
16355 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
16356 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
16359 and simply specify your predicate as:
16365 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
16366 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
16367 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
16368 just don't give a damn.
16370 The above predicates apply to *all* the groups which belong to the
16371 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
16372 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
16373 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in it's group
16374 parameters like so:
16377 (agent-predicate . short)
16380 This is the group parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
16381 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
16382 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
16384 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
16387 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
16390 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
16391 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
16392 predicate is assumed to be a list.
16395 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
16396 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
16397 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
16398 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
16399 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
16400 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
16402 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
16403 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
16404 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
16405 if it's to be specific to that group.
16407 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
16414 This has the same syntax as a normal gnus score file except only a
16415 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
16421 Category specification
16425 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
16431 Group Parameter specification
16434 (agent-score ("from"
16435 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
16440 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
16446 These score files must *only* contain the permitted scoring keywords
16453 Category specification
16456 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
16462 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
16466 Group Parameter specification
16469 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
16472 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
16477 Use @code{normal} score files
16479 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
16480 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
16481 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
16482 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
16484 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
16485 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
16486 files for a group, *filtering out* those sections that do not
16487 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
16491 Category Specification
16498 Group Parameter specification
16501 (agent-score . file)
16506 @node Category Buffer
16507 @subsubsection Category Buffer
16509 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
16510 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
16511 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
16513 The following commands are available in this buffer:
16517 @kindex q (Category)
16518 @findex gnus-category-exit
16519 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
16522 @kindex k (Category)
16523 @findex gnus-category-kill
16524 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
16527 @kindex c (Category)
16528 @findex gnus-category-copy
16529 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
16532 @kindex a (Category)
16533 @findex gnus-category-add
16534 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
16537 @kindex p (Category)
16538 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
16539 Edit the predicate of the current category
16540 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
16543 @kindex g (Category)
16544 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
16545 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
16546 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
16549 @kindex s (Category)
16550 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
16551 Edit the download score rule of the current category
16552 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
16555 @kindex l (Category)
16556 @findex gnus-category-list
16557 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
16561 @node Category Variables
16562 @subsubsection Category Variables
16565 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
16566 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
16567 Hook run in category buffers.
16569 @item gnus-category-line-format
16570 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
16571 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
16572 Variables}). Valid elements are:
16576 The name of the category.
16579 The number of groups in the category.
16582 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
16583 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
16584 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
16586 @item gnus-agent-short-article
16587 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
16588 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
16590 @item gnus-agent-long-article
16591 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
16592 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
16594 @item gnus-agent-low-score
16595 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
16596 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
16599 @item gnus-agent-high-score
16600 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
16601 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
16607 @node Agent Commands
16608 @subsection Agent Commands
16610 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
16611 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
16612 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
16616 * Group Agent Commands::
16617 * Summary Agent Commands::
16618 * Server Agent Commands::
16621 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
16622 following incantation:
16624 @cindex gnus-agent-batch
16626 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch
16631 @node Group Agent Commands
16632 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
16636 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
16637 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
16638 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
16639 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
16642 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
16643 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
16644 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
16647 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
16648 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
16649 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
16650 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
16653 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
16654 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
16655 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
16656 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
16659 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
16660 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
16661 Add the current group to an Agent category
16662 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
16663 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
16666 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
16667 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
16668 Remove the current group from its category, if any
16669 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
16670 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
16673 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
16674 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
16675 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
16681 @node Summary Agent Commands
16682 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
16686 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
16687 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
16688 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
16691 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
16692 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
16693 Remove the downloading mark from the article
16694 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
16697 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
16698 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
16699 Toggle whether to download the article (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}).
16702 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
16703 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
16704 Mark all undownloaded articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}).
16707 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
16708 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
16709 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
16710 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
16715 @node Server Agent Commands
16716 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
16720 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
16721 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
16722 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
16723 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
16726 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
16727 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
16728 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
16729 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
16735 @subsection Agent Expiry
16737 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
16738 @findex gnus-agent-expire
16739 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
16740 @cindex Agent expiry
16741 @cindex Gnus Agent expiry
16744 @code{nnagent} doesn't handle expiry. Instead, there's a special
16745 @code{gnus-agent-expire} command that will expire all read articles that
16746 are older than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. It can be run
16747 whenever you feel that you're running out of space. It's not
16748 particularly fast or efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to
16749 interrupt it (with @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started it.
16751 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} can also be a list of regexp/day pairs.
16752 The regexps will be matched against group names to allow differing
16753 expiry in different groups.
16756 (setq gnus-agent-expire-days
16762 If you use the list form, the last element must always be the default
16763 method---it must always match all groups.
16765 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
16766 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, this command will
16767 expire all articles---unread, read, ticked and dormant. If @code{nil}
16768 (which is the default), only read articles are eligible for expiry, and
16769 unread, ticked and dormant articles will be kept indefinitely.
16771 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
16772 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
16773 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's a special
16774 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} command to fix possible problems.
16776 @node Agent and IMAP
16777 @subsection Agent and IMAP
16779 The Agent work with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
16780 since there are some conceptual differences between @sc{nntp} and
16781 @sc{imap}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
16782 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @sc{imap} Disconnected Mode client.
16784 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
16785 are kept on the @sc{imap} server, rather than in @code{.newsrc} as is the
16786 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
16787 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
16789 Gnus keep track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
16790 Agent by default. When you plug back in, by default Gnus will check if
16791 you have any changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these
16792 with the server. This behavior is customizable with
16793 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
16795 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
16796 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
16797 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, the
16798 default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so ask if
16799 you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has any other
16800 value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
16802 If you do not wish to automatically synchronize flags when you
16803 re-connect, this can be done manually with the
16804 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
16805 in the group buffer by default.
16807 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
16808 expect from a disconnected @sc{imap} client, including:
16813 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
16816 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
16820 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by "pushing"
16821 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
16822 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
16823 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on a article, quit the group and
16824 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
16825 removed from the server when you "synchronize". The queued flag
16826 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
16827 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
16830 @node Outgoing Messages
16831 @subsection Outgoing Messages
16833 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
16834 stored in the draft groups (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view them there
16835 after posting, and edit them at will.
16837 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
16838 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
16839 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
16840 messages in the draft group.
16844 @node Agent Variables
16845 @subsection Agent Variables
16848 @item gnus-agent-directory
16849 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
16850 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
16851 @file{~/News/agent/}.
16853 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
16854 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
16855 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
16856 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
16857 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
16860 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
16861 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
16862 Hook run when connecting to the network.
16864 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
16865 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
16866 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
16868 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
16869 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
16870 Hook run when after finishing fetching articles.
16872 @item gnus-agent-cache
16873 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
16874 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @sc{nov} and articles when
16877 @item gnus-agent-go-online
16878 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
16879 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
16880 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
16881 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
16882 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
16883 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
16889 @node Example Setup
16890 @subsection Example Setup
16892 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
16893 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
16894 @file{.gnus.el} file to get started.
16897 ;;; Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @sc{nntp}
16898 ;;; from your ISP's server.
16899 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
16901 ;;; Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from
16902 ;;; your ISP's POP server.
16903 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
16905 ;;; Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.
16906 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
16908 ;;; Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.
16909 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; The obsolete setting.
16910 (setq gnus-agent t)
16913 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
16914 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
16917 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
16918 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
16919 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
16920 @sc{nntp} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
16921 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
16924 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
16925 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
16926 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
16927 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
16928 back all the killed groups.)
16930 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
16931 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
16932 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
16935 @node Batching Agents
16936 @subsection Batching Agents
16938 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
16939 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
16940 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
16944 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null
16948 @node Agent Caveats
16949 @subsection Agent Caveats
16951 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
16952 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
16956 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
16960 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
16962 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is `nil'.
16966 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
16967 articles; when it's plugged, it only talks to your ISP and also uses the
16968 locally stored articles.
16975 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
16976 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
16977 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
16980 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
16981 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
16982 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
16983 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
16984 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
16986 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
16987 before generating the summary buffer.
16989 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
16990 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
16991 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
16993 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
16994 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
16995 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
16996 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
16999 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
17000 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
17001 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
17002 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
17003 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
17004 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
17005 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
17006 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
17007 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
17008 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
17009 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
17010 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
17011 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
17012 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
17013 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
17014 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
17015 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
17019 @node Summary Score Commands
17020 @section Summary Score Commands
17021 @cindex score commands
17023 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
17024 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
17025 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
17026 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
17027 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
17029 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
17030 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
17031 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
17032 score file the current one.
17034 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
17039 @kindex V s (Summary)
17040 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
17041 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
17044 @kindex V S (Summary)
17045 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
17046 Display the score of the current article
17047 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
17050 @kindex V t (Summary)
17051 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
17052 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
17053 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}).
17056 @kindex V w (Summary)
17057 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
17058 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
17061 @kindex V R (Summary)
17062 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
17063 Run the current summary through the scoring process
17064 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
17065 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
17066 effect you're having.
17069 @kindex V c (Summary)
17070 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
17071 Make a different score file the current
17072 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
17075 @kindex V e (Summary)
17076 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
17077 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
17078 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
17082 @kindex V f (Summary)
17083 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
17084 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
17085 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
17088 @kindex V F (Summary)
17089 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
17090 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
17091 after editing score files.
17094 @kindex V C (Summary)
17095 @findex gnus-score-customize
17096 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
17097 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
17101 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
17106 @kindex V m (Summary)
17107 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
17108 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
17109 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
17112 @kindex V x (Summary)
17113 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
17114 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
17115 expunge all articles below this score
17116 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
17119 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
17120 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
17123 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
17124 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
17128 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
17129 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
17131 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
17132 keys are available:
17136 Score on the author name.
17139 Score on the subject line.
17142 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
17145 Score on the @code{References} line.
17151 Score on the number of lines.
17154 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
17157 Score on an "extra" header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
17158 if your @sc{nntp} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
17161 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
17162 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
17163 @file{ADAPT} files.)
17172 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
17178 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
17179 what headers you are scoring on.
17191 Substring matching.
17194 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
17223 Greater than number.
17228 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
17229 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
17230 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
17235 Temporary score entry.
17238 Permanent score entry.
17241 Immediately scoring.
17245 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
17246 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
17247 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
17251 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
17252 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
17253 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
17254 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
17256 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
17257 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
17258 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
17259 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
17260 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
17262 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
17263 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
17264 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
17265 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
17266 current score file.
17268 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
17269 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
17270 pretend they are keymaps or not.
17273 @node Group Score Commands
17274 @section Group Score Commands
17275 @cindex group score commands
17277 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
17282 @kindex W f (Group)
17283 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
17284 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
17285 all the time. This command will flush the cache
17286 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
17290 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
17292 @findex gnus-batch-score
17293 @cindex batch scoring
17295 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
17299 @node Score Variables
17300 @section Score Variables
17301 @cindex score variables
17305 @item gnus-use-scoring
17306 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
17307 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
17308 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
17310 @item gnus-kill-killed
17311 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
17312 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
17313 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
17314 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
17315 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
17316 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
17317 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
17319 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
17320 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
17321 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
17322 initialized from the @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
17323 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
17325 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
17326 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
17327 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
17328 (@samp{SCORE} by default.)
17330 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
17331 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
17332 @cindex score cache
17333 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
17334 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
17335 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
17336 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
17337 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
17338 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
17341 @item gnus-save-score
17342 @vindex gnus-save-score
17343 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
17344 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
17345 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
17347 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
17348 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
17349 across group visits.
17351 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
17352 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
17353 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
17354 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
17355 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
17356 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
17357 manually entered data.
17359 @item gnus-summary-default-score
17360 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
17361 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
17363 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
17364 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
17365 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
17366 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
17367 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
17368 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
17370 @item gnus-score-over-mark
17371 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
17372 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
17373 default. Default is @samp{+}.
17375 @item gnus-score-below-mark
17376 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
17377 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
17378 default. Default is @samp{-}.
17380 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
17381 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
17382 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
17383 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
17385 Predefined functions available are:
17388 @item gnus-score-find-single
17389 @findex gnus-score-find-single
17390 Only apply the group's own score file.
17392 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
17393 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
17394 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
17395 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
17396 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
17397 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
17398 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
17399 then a regexp match is done.
17401 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
17402 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
17404 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
17405 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
17406 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
17407 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
17409 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
17410 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
17411 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
17412 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
17413 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
17417 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
17418 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
17419 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
17420 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
17421 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
17422 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
17423 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
17426 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
17427 overall score file, you could use the value
17429 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
17430 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
17433 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
17434 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
17435 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
17436 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
17437 are expired. It's 7 by default.
17439 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
17440 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
17441 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
17442 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
17443 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
17444 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
17445 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
17446 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
17448 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
17449 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
17450 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
17452 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
17453 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
17454 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be simplified
17455 for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
17456 threading---according to the current value of
17457 gnus-simplify-subject-functions. If the scoring entry uses
17458 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
17459 simplified in this manner.
17464 @node Score File Format
17465 @section Score File Format
17466 @cindex score file format
17468 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
17469 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
17470 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
17472 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
17476 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
17478 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
17480 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
17482 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
17487 (mark-and-expunge -10)
17491 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
17492 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
17493 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
17494 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
17498 This example demonstrates most score file elements. For a different
17499 approach, see @pxref{Advanced Scoring}.
17501 Even though this looks much like lisp code, nothing here is actually
17502 @code{eval}ed. The lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
17503 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
17505 Six keys are supported by this alist:
17510 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
17511 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
17512 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
17513 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
17514 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
17515 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
17516 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
17517 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
17518 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
17519 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
17520 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
17521 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
17522 to articles that matches these score entries.
17524 Following this key is a arbitrary number of score entries, where each
17525 score entry has one to four elements.
17529 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
17530 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
17534 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
17535 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
17536 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
17537 is successful. If this element is not present, the
17538 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
17539 instead. This is 1000 by default.
17542 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
17543 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
17544 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
17545 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
17546 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
17549 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
17550 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
17551 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
17552 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
17555 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
17556 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
17557 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
17558 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
17559 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
17560 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
17561 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
17562 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
17563 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
17564 instead, if you feel like.
17567 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
17568 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
17569 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
17570 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
17571 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin host,
17572 if your @sc{nntp} server tracks NNTP-Posting-Host in overviews:
17575 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s "NNTP-Posting-Host")
17579 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
17580 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
17582 These predicates are true if
17585 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
17588 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
17589 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
17596 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
17597 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
17598 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
17599 it's not. I think.)
17601 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
17602 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
17603 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
17604 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
17607 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
17608 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
17609 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
17610 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
17611 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
17612 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
17613 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
17617 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
17618 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
17619 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
17620 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
17621 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
17622 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
17623 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
17624 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
17627 @item Head, Body, All
17628 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
17632 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
17633 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
17634 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
17635 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
17636 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
17637 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
17638 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
17642 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
17643 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
17644 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
17645 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
17646 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
17647 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
17648 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
17649 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
17650 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
17651 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
17652 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
17656 @cindex Score File Atoms
17658 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
17659 lower than this number will be marked as read.
17662 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
17663 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
17665 @item mark-and-expunge
17666 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
17667 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
17670 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
17671 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
17672 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
17673 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
17674 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
17677 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
17678 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
17681 @item exclude-files
17682 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
17683 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
17687 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
17688 ignored when handling global score files.
17691 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
17692 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
17693 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
17694 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
17697 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
17698 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
17699 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
17700 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
17702 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
17706 (mark-and-expunge -100)
17709 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
17710 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
17711 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
17712 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
17713 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
17715 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
17716 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
17717 scoring rules exist.
17720 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
17721 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
17722 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
17723 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
17724 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
17725 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
17726 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
17727 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
17728 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
17729 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
17730 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
17734 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
17735 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
17736 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
17737 file for a number of groups.
17740 @cindex local variables
17741 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(VAR VALUE)} pairs.
17742 Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the current summary buffer,
17743 and set to the value specified. This is a convenient, if somewhat
17744 strange, way of setting variables in some groups if you don't like hooks
17745 much. Note that the @var{value} won't be evaluated.
17749 @node Score File Editing
17750 @section Score File Editing
17752 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
17753 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
17754 with a mode for that.
17756 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
17757 additional commands:
17762 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
17763 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
17764 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
17765 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
17768 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
17769 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
17770 Insert the current date in numerical format
17771 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
17772 you were wondering.
17775 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
17776 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
17777 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
17778 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
17779 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
17784 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
17786 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
17787 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
17789 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f} and @kbd{V
17790 e} to begin editing score files.
17793 @node Adaptive Scoring
17794 @section Adaptive Scoring
17795 @cindex adaptive scoring
17797 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
17798 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
17799 stupidity, to be precise.
17801 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
17802 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
17803 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
17804 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
17805 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
17806 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
17807 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
17808 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
17809 variable to @code{(word line)}.
17811 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
17812 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
17813 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
17814 might look something like this:
17817 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
17818 '((gnus-unread-mark)
17819 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
17820 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
17821 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
17822 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
17823 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
17824 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
17825 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
17826 (gnus-ancient-mark)
17827 (gnus-low-score-mark)
17828 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
17831 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
17832 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
17833 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
17834 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
17835 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
17836 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
17839 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
17840 will be applied to each article.
17842 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
17843 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{D}) will have a
17844 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
17845 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
17847 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
17848 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
17849 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
17850 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
17852 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
17853 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
17854 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
17855 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
17857 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
17858 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
17859 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
17860 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
17861 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
17862 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
17864 You can also score on @code{thread}, which will try to score all
17865 articles that appear in a thread. @code{thread} matches uses a
17866 @code{Message-ID} to match on the @code{References} header of the
17867 article. If the match is made, the @code{Message-ID} of the article is
17868 added to the @code{thread} rule. (Think about it. I'd recommend two
17869 aspirins afterwards.)
17871 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
17872 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
17873 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
17875 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
17876 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
17877 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
17879 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
17880 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
17881 let you use different rules in different groups.
17883 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
17884 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
17885 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
17888 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
17889 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
17890 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
17891 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
17892 the length of the match is less than
17893 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
17894 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
17897 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
17898 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
17899 headers. If you adapt on words, the
17900 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
17901 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
17904 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
17905 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
17906 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
17907 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
17908 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
17911 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
17912 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
17913 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
17914 score with 30 points.
17916 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
17917 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
17918 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
17919 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
17920 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
17922 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
17923 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
17924 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
17925 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
17926 variable defaults til @code{nil}.
17928 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
17929 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
17930 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
17931 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
17933 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
17934 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
17935 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
17936 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
17938 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
17939 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
17940 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
17941 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
17942 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
17944 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
17945 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
17946 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
17948 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
17949 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
17950 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
17951 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
17954 @node Home Score File
17955 @section Home Score File
17957 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
17958 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
17959 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
17960 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
17962 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
17963 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
17964 could perhaps use the same home score file.
17966 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
17967 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
17972 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
17976 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
17977 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
17981 A list. The elements in this list can be:
17985 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
17986 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
17989 A function. If the function returns non-nil, the result will be used as
17990 the home score file.
17993 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
17996 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
18001 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
18004 (setq gnus-home-score-file
18005 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
18008 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
18009 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
18011 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
18013 (setq gnus-home-score-file
18014 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
18017 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
18018 Other functions include
18021 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
18022 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
18023 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
18024 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
18028 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
18029 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
18030 their own home score files:
18033 (setq gnus-home-score-file
18034 ;; All groups that match the regexp "\\.emacs"
18035 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
18036 ;; All the comp groups in one score file
18037 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
18040 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
18041 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
18042 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
18043 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
18044 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
18046 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
18047 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
18048 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
18049 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
18050 precedence over this variable.
18053 @node Followups To Yourself
18054 @section Followups To Yourself
18056 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
18057 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
18058 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
18059 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
18060 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
18061 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
18065 @item gnus-score-followup-article
18066 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
18067 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
18070 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
18071 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
18072 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
18076 @vindex message-sent-hook
18077 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
18078 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
18080 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
18084 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
18085 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
18089 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
18090 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
18093 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
18094 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
18099 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
18103 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
18104 is system-dependent.
18107 @node Scoring On Other Headers
18108 @section Scoring On Other Headers
18109 @cindex scoring on other headers
18111 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
18112 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
18113 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
18114 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
18115 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
18117 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
18118 mail groups, you have greater control. In the @pxref{To From
18119 Newsgroups} section of the manual, it's explained in greater detail what
18120 this mechanism does, but here's a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on
18121 how to allow scoring on the @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
18123 Put the following in your @file{.gnus.el} file.
18126 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
18127 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
18130 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
18131 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
18132 time if you have much mail.
18134 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
18135 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
18141 @section Scoring Tips
18142 @cindex scoring tips
18148 @cindex scoring crossposts
18149 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
18150 the @code{Xref} header.
18152 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
18155 @item Multiple crossposts
18156 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
18157 more than, say, 3 groups:
18160 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
18164 @item Matching on the body
18165 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
18166 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
18167 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
18168 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
18169 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
18170 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
18171 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
18174 @item Marking as read
18175 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
18176 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
18177 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
18181 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
18183 @item Negated character classes
18184 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
18185 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
18186 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
18190 @node Reverse Scoring
18191 @section Reverse Scoring
18192 @cindex reverse scoring
18194 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
18195 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
18196 like this in your score file:
18200 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
18205 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
18206 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
18209 @node Global Score Files
18210 @section Global Score Files
18211 @cindex global score files
18213 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
18214 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
18215 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
18217 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
18218 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
18219 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
18221 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
18222 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
18223 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
18224 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
18225 files are applicable to which group.
18227 To use the score file
18228 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
18229 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
18233 (setq gnus-global-score-files
18234 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
18235 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
18238 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
18240 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
18241 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
18242 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
18243 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
18245 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
18246 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
18248 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
18249 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
18250 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
18251 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
18252 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
18253 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
18255 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
18261 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
18263 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
18265 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
18267 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
18268 lowered out of existence.
18270 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
18271 articles completely.
18274 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
18275 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
18276 old articles for a long time.
18279 ... I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
18280 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
18281 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
18282 holding our breath yet?
18286 @section Kill Files
18289 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
18290 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
18291 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
18293 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
18294 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
18295 files into score files.
18297 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
18298 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
18299 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
18300 that isn't a very good idea.
18302 Normal kill files look like this:
18305 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
18306 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
18310 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
18311 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
18313 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
18314 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
18317 Two summary functions for editing a GNUS kill file:
18322 @kindex M-k (Summary)
18323 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
18324 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
18327 @kindex M-K (Summary)
18328 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
18329 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
18332 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
18337 @kindex M-k (Group)
18338 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
18339 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
18342 @kindex M-K (Group)
18343 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
18344 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
18347 Kill file variables:
18350 @item gnus-kill-file-name
18351 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
18352 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
18353 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
18354 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
18355 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
18356 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
18358 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
18359 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
18360 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
18361 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
18364 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
18365 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
18366 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
18367 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
18368 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
18369 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
18370 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
18371 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
18372 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
18374 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
18375 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
18376 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
18381 @node Converting Kill Files
18382 @section Converting Kill Files
18384 @cindex converting kill files
18386 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
18387 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
18388 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
18391 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
18392 You can fetch it from
18393 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
18395 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
18396 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
18397 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
18405 GroupLens (@uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/}) is a
18406 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
18407 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
18408 news articles generated every day.
18410 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
18411 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
18412 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
18413 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
18414 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
18415 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
18416 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
18417 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
18420 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
18421 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
18424 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
18425 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
18426 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
18427 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
18431 @node Using GroupLens
18432 @subsection Using GroupLens
18434 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local Better
18436 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html} is the only
18437 better bit in town at the moment.
18439 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
18443 @item gnus-use-grouplens
18444 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
18445 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
18446 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
18448 @item grouplens-pseudonym
18449 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
18450 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
18451 with the Better Bit Bureau.
18453 @item grouplens-newsgroups
18454 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
18455 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
18459 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
18460 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
18461 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
18462 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
18463 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
18464 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
18467 @node Rating Articles
18468 @subsection Rating Articles
18470 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
18471 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
18472 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
18473 yourself is, "on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
18476 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
18481 @kindex r (GroupLens)
18482 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
18483 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
18486 @kindex k (GroupLens)
18487 @findex grouplens-score-thread
18488 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
18489 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
18490 threads in rec.humor.
18494 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
18495 the score of the article you're reading.
18500 @kindex n (GroupLens)
18501 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
18502 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
18505 @kindex , (GroupLens)
18506 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
18507 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
18511 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
18512 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
18515 @node Displaying Predictions
18516 @subsection Displaying Predictions
18518 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
18519 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
18520 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
18521 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
18522 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
18524 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
18525 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
18526 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
18527 regular gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
18528 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
18529 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
18530 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
18531 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
18532 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
18533 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
18534 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
18535 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
18536 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
18538 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
18539 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
18540 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
18541 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
18543 The following are valid values for that variable.
18546 @item prediction-spot
18547 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
18550 @item confidence-interval
18551 A numeric confidence interval.
18553 @item prediction-bar
18554 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
18556 @item confidence-bar
18557 Numerical confidence.
18559 @item confidence-spot
18560 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
18562 @item prediction-num
18563 Plain-old numeric value.
18565 @item confidence-plus-minus
18566 Prediction +/- confidence.
18571 @node GroupLens Variables
18572 @subsection GroupLens Variables
18576 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
18577 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
18578 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
18579 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
18582 @item grouplens-bbb-host
18583 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
18586 @item grouplens-bbb-port
18587 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
18589 @item grouplens-score-offset
18590 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
18591 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
18594 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
18595 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
18596 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
18601 @node Advanced Scoring
18602 @section Advanced Scoring
18604 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
18605 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
18606 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
18607 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
18608 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
18610 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
18614 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
18615 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
18616 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
18620 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
18621 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
18623 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
18624 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
18625 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
18626 non-@code{nil} value.
18628 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
18629 operator, and various match operators.
18636 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
18637 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
18638 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
18643 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
18644 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
18645 then this operator will return @code{false}.
18650 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
18651 logical negation of the value of its argument.
18655 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
18656 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
18657 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
18658 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
18659 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
18660 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
18661 the ancestry you want to go.
18663 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
18664 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
18665 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
18666 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
18667 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
18670 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
18671 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
18673 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
18674 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
18677 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
18678 when he's talking about Gnus:
18682 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
18683 ("subject" "Gnus"))
18689 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
18693 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
18700 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
18701 really don't want to read what he's written:
18705 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
18706 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
18710 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
18711 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
18712 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
18719 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
18720 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
18721 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
18722 ("body" "white.*socks"))
18726 The possibilities are endless.
18729 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
18730 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
18732 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
18733 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
18734 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
18735 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
18736 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
18737 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
18738 @samp{subject}) first.
18740 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
18741 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
18752 Then that means "score on the from header of the grandparent of the
18753 current article". An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
18759 ("subject" "Gnus")))
18766 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
18767 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
18772 @section Score Decays
18773 @cindex score decays
18776 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
18777 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
18778 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
18779 use them in any sensible way.
18781 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
18782 @findex gnus-decay-score
18783 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
18784 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
18785 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
18786 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
18787 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
18788 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
18789 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
18790 definition of that function:
18793 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
18795 This is done according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
18796 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
18799 (* (if (< score 0) 1 -1)
18801 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
18803 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
18806 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
18807 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
18808 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
18809 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
18813 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
18816 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
18819 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
18823 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
18824 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
18825 the new score, which should be an integer.
18827 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
18828 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
18833 @include message.texi
18834 @chapter Emacs MIME
18835 @include emacs-mime.texi
18837 @include sieve.texi
18845 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
18846 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
18847 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
18848 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
18849 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
18850 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
18851 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
18852 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
18853 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
18854 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
18855 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
18856 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
18857 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
18858 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
18859 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
18860 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
18861 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
18862 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
18863 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
18867 @node Process/Prefix
18868 @section Process/Prefix
18869 @cindex process/prefix convention
18871 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
18872 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
18874 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
18875 command to be performed on.
18879 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
18880 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
18881 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
18882 with the current one.
18884 @vindex transient-mark-mode
18885 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
18886 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
18888 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
18889 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
18892 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
18893 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
18895 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
18898 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
18899 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
18900 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
18901 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
18903 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
18904 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
18905 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
18906 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
18907 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
18908 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
18909 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
18910 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
18912 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
18913 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
18914 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
18915 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
18916 expirable, you could say `M P b M-& E'.
18920 @section Interactive
18921 @cindex interaction
18925 @item gnus-novice-user
18926 @vindex gnus-novice-user
18927 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
18928 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
18929 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
18930 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
18933 @item gnus-expert-user
18934 @vindex gnus-expert-user
18935 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
18936 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
18937 matter how strange.
18939 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
18940 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
18941 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
18942 is @code{t} by default.
18944 @item gnus-interactive-exit
18945 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
18946 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
18951 @node Symbolic Prefixes
18952 @section Symbolic Prefixes
18953 @cindex symbolic prefixes
18955 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
18956 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
18957 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
18958 rule of 900 to the current article.
18960 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
18961 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
18962 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
18963 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
18964 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
18965 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
18966 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
18968 @kindex M-i (Summary)
18969 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
18970 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
18971 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
18972 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
18973 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
18974 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
18975 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
18976 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
18978 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
18979 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
18980 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
18982 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
18986 @node Formatting Variables
18987 @section Formatting Variables
18988 @cindex formatting variables
18990 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
18991 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
18992 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
18993 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
18994 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
18997 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
18998 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
18999 lots of percentages everywhere.
19002 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
19003 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
19004 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
19005 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
19006 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
19007 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
19008 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
19009 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
19012 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
19013 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
19014 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
19015 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
19016 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
19017 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
19018 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
19019 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
19021 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
19022 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
19024 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
19025 @findex gnus-update-format
19026 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
19027 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
19028 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
19029 examine the resulting lisp code to be run to generate the line.
19033 @node Formatting Basics
19034 @subsection Formatting Basics
19036 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
19037 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
19038 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
19040 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
19041 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
19042 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
19043 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
19044 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
19047 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
19048 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
19049 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
19050 less than 4 characters wide.
19052 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
19053 @samp{%&user-date;}.
19056 @node Mode Line Formatting
19057 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
19059 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
19060 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
19061 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
19062 with the following two differences:
19067 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
19070 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
19071 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
19072 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
19073 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
19074 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
19075 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
19076 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
19081 @node Advanced Formatting
19082 @subsection Advanced Formatting
19084 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
19085 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
19086 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
19087 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
19089 These are the valid modifiers:
19094 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
19098 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
19103 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
19106 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
19111 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
19114 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
19117 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
19120 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
19126 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
19131 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
19132 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
19133 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
19134 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
19135 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
19136 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
19137 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
19139 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
19140 last operation, padding.
19142 @vindex gnus-compile-user-specs
19143 If @code{gnus-compile-user-specs} is set to @code{nil} (@code{t} by
19144 default) with your strong personality, and use a lots of these advanced
19145 thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets quite slow. This can be helped
19146 enormously by running @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with
19147 the look of your lines.
19148 @xref{Compilation}.
19151 @node User-Defined Specs
19152 @subsection User-Defined Specs
19154 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
19155 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
19156 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
19157 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
19158 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
19159 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
19160 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
19161 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
19162 should protect against that.
19164 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
19165 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
19167 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
19168 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
19169 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
19170 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
19174 @node Formatting Fonts
19175 @subsection Formatting Fonts
19177 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
19178 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
19179 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
19180 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
19183 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
19184 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
19185 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
19186 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
19187 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
19188 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
19190 Text inside the @samp{%<} and @samp{%>} specifiers will get the special
19191 @code{balloon-help} property set to @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you
19192 say @samp{%1<}, you'll get @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The
19193 @code{gnus-balloon-face-*} variables should be either strings or symbols
19194 naming functions that return a string. Under @code{balloon-help-mode},
19195 when the mouse passes over text with this property set, a balloon window
19196 will appear and display the string. Please refer to the doc string of
19197 @code{balloon-help-mode} for more information on this.
19199 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
19202 ;; Create three face types.
19203 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
19204 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
19206 ;; We want the article count to be in
19207 ;; a bold and green face. So we create
19208 ;; a new face called `my-green-bold'.
19209 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
19211 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
19212 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
19214 ;; Set the new & fancy format.
19215 (setq gnus-group-line-format
19216 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
19219 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
19220 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
19222 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
19223 mode-line variables.
19225 @node Positioning Point
19226 @subsection Positioning Point
19228 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
19229 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
19230 line. You can customize this behaviour in three different ways.
19232 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
19234 @findex gnus-goto-colon
19235 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
19236 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
19238 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
19239 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%C} specifier. If you
19240 put a @samp{%C} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
19245 @subsection Tabulation
19247 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
19248 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
19249 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
19250 about lining up the following text afterwards.
19252 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs--@samp{%=}. There are two
19253 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
19255 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
19256 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
19257 This is the soft tabulator.
19259 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
19260 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
19261 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
19264 @node Wide Characters
19265 @subsection Wide Characters
19267 Proportional fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
19268 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
19269 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
19271 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
19272 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
19273 these coutries, that's not true.
19275 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
19276 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
19277 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
19278 prettieer. The default value is @code{t}.
19282 @node Window Layout
19283 @section Window Layout
19284 @cindex window layout
19286 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
19288 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
19289 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
19290 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
19291 @code{t} by default.
19293 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
19294 glitches. Use at your own peril.
19296 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
19297 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
19298 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
19301 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
19302 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
19303 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
19307 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
19308 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
19309 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
19310 possible names is listed below.
19312 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
19313 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
19316 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
19320 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
19321 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
19322 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
19323 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
19324 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
19325 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
19326 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
19327 size spec per split.
19329 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
19330 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
19331 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
19332 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
19333 present) gets focus.
19335 Here's a more complicated example:
19338 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
19339 (summary 0.25 point)
19340 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
19344 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
19345 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
19346 occupy, not a percentage.
19348 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
19349 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
19350 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
19351 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
19352 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
19355 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
19358 (article (horizontal 1.0
19363 (summary 0.25 point)
19368 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
19369 @code{horizontal} thingie?
19371 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
19372 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
19373 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
19374 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
19375 the screen is to be given to this strip.
19377 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
19378 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
19379 lines from the splits.
19381 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
19385 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
19386 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
19387 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
19388 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
19389 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
19390 size = number | frame-params
19391 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
19394 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
19395 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
19396 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
19397 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
19399 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
19400 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
19401 @cindex window height
19402 @cindex window width
19403 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
19404 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
19405 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
19406 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
19407 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
19408 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
19410 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
19411 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
19412 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
19413 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
19415 @findex gnus-configure-frame
19416 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
19417 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
19418 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
19419 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
19420 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
19421 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
19422 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
19423 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
19424 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
19425 configuration list.
19428 (gnus-configure-frame
19432 (article 0.3 point))
19440 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
19441 @code{frame} split:
19444 (gnus-configure-frame
19447 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
19449 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
19450 (user-position . t)
19451 (left . -1) (top . 1))
19456 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
19457 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
19458 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
19459 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
19460 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
19461 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
19462 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
19463 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
19465 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
19466 be found in its default value.
19468 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
19469 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
19470 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
19474 (message (horizontal 1.0
19475 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
19477 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
19482 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
19483 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
19484 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
19489 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
19490 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
19491 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
19492 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
19493 (name . "Message"))
19494 (message 1.0 point))))
19497 @findex gnus-add-configuration
19498 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
19499 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
19500 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
19501 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
19504 (gnus-add-configuration
19505 '(article (vertical 1.0
19507 (summary .25 point)
19511 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
19512 @file{.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
19513 Gnus has been loaded.
19515 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
19516 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
19517 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
19518 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
19519 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
19521 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
19522 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
19523 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
19526 @subsection Example Window Configurations
19530 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
19531 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
19546 (gnus-add-configuration
19549 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
19551 (summary 0.16 point)
19554 (gnus-add-configuration
19557 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
19558 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
19564 @node Faces and Fonts
19565 @section Faces and Fonts
19570 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
19571 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
19572 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
19577 @section Compilation
19578 @cindex compilation
19579 @cindex byte-compilation
19581 @findex gnus-compile
19583 Remember all those line format specification variables?
19584 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
19585 on. By default, T-gnus will use the byte-compiled codes of these
19586 variables and we can keep a slow-down to a minimum. However, if you set
19587 @code{gnus-compile-user-specs} to @code{nil} (@code{t} by default),
19588 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
19589 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
19590 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
19593 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
19594 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
19595 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
19596 you'll get top speed again. Note that T-gnus will not save these
19597 compiled specs in the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19600 @item gnus-compile-user-specs
19601 @vindex gnus-compile-user-specs
19602 If it is non-nil, the user-defined format specs will be byte-compiled
19603 automatically. The default value of this variable is @code{t}. It has
19604 an effect on the values of @code{gnus-*-line-format-spec}.
19609 @section Mode Lines
19612 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
19613 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
19614 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
19615 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
19616 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
19617 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
19618 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
19621 @cindex display-time
19623 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
19624 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
19625 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
19626 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
19627 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
19628 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
19629 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
19630 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
19633 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
19635 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
19636 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
19638 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
19639 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
19640 (length display-time-string)))))
19643 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
19644 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
19645 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
19646 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
19647 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
19650 @node Highlighting and Menus
19651 @section Highlighting and Menus
19653 @cindex highlighting
19656 @vindex gnus-visual
19657 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
19658 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
19659 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
19662 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
19663 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
19666 @item group-highlight
19667 Do highlights in the group buffer.
19668 @item summary-highlight
19669 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
19670 @item article-highlight
19671 Do highlights in the article buffer.
19673 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
19675 Create menus in the group buffer.
19677 Create menus in the summary buffers.
19679 Create menus in the article buffer.
19681 Create menus in the browse buffer.
19683 Create menus in the server buffer.
19685 Create menus in the score buffers.
19687 Create menus in all buffers.
19690 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
19691 buffers, you could say something like:
19694 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
19697 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
19700 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
19703 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
19704 in all Gnus buffers.
19706 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
19709 @item gnus-mouse-face
19710 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
19711 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
19712 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
19716 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
19720 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
19721 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
19722 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
19724 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
19725 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
19726 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
19728 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
19729 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
19730 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
19732 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
19733 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
19734 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
19736 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
19737 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
19738 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
19740 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
19741 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
19742 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
19753 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
19754 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
19755 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
19756 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
19757 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
19761 @vindex gnus-carpal
19762 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
19763 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
19764 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
19769 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
19770 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
19771 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
19773 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
19774 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
19775 Face used on buttons.
19777 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
19778 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
19779 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
19781 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
19782 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
19783 Buttons in the group buffer.
19785 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
19786 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
19787 Buttons in the summary buffer.
19789 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
19790 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
19791 Buttons in the server buffer.
19793 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
19794 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
19795 Buttons in the browse buffer.
19798 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
19799 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
19800 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
19808 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
19809 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
19810 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
19811 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
19812 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
19814 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
19815 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
19816 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
19818 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
19819 been idle for thirty minutes:
19822 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
19825 Here's a handler that scans for PGP headers every hour when Emacs is
19829 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
19832 This @var{time} parameter and than @var{idle} parameter work together
19833 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
19834 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
19836 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
19837 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
19838 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
19839 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
19841 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
19842 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
19843 @var{idle} minutes.
19845 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
19846 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
19849 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
19850 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
19851 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
19853 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
19854 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
19855 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
19856 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
19858 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
19859 your @file{.gnus} file:
19861 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
19863 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
19866 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
19867 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
19868 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
19869 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
19870 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
19871 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
19872 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
19873 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
19874 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
19875 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
19876 @file{.gnus} if you want those abilities.
19878 @findex gnus-demon-init
19879 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
19880 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
19881 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
19882 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
19883 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
19885 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
19886 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
19887 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
19896 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
19897 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
19899 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
19900 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
19901 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
19902 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
19905 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
19906 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
19907 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
19908 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
19910 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
19911 this will make spam disappear.
19913 There are some variables to customize, of course:
19916 @item gnus-use-nocem
19917 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
19918 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
19921 @item gnus-nocem-groups
19922 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
19923 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
19924 default is @code{("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
19925 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")}.
19927 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
19928 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
19929 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
19930 people you want to listen to. The default is @code{("Automoose-1"
19931 "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo"
19932 "hweede@@snafu.de")}; fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
19934 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at
19935 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
19937 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
19938 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
19939 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
19940 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
19941 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
19942 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
19943 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
19944 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
19945 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
19946 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
19948 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
19949 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
19952 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
19955 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
19956 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
19959 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
19962 The specs are applied left-to-right.
19965 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
19966 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
19968 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
19969 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
19970 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
19971 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
19973 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
19974 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
19977 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
19979 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
19987 This might be dangerous, though.
19989 @item gnus-nocem-directory
19990 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
19991 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is
19992 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
19994 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
19995 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
19996 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
19997 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
19998 might then see old spam.
20000 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
20001 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
20002 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
20003 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
20004 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
20007 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
20008 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
20009 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
20010 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
20014 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
20015 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
20016 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
20017 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
20024 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
20025 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
20026 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
20028 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
20029 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
20030 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
20031 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
20032 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
20033 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
20034 @code{undo} function.
20036 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
20037 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
20038 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
20039 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
20040 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
20041 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
20042 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
20043 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
20044 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
20045 never be totally undoable.
20047 @findex gnus-undo-mode
20048 @vindex gnus-use-undo
20050 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
20051 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
20052 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
20053 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
20057 @node Predicate Specifiers
20058 @section Predicate Specifiers
20059 @cindex predicate specifiers
20061 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
20062 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
20063 to type all that much.
20065 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
20070 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
20071 gnus-article-unread-p)
20074 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
20075 functions all take one parameter.
20077 @findex gnus-make-predicate
20078 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
20079 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
20080 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
20085 @section Moderation
20088 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
20089 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
20090 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
20093 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
20097 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
20100 in your @file{.gnus.el} file.
20102 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
20107 You split your incoming mail by matching on
20108 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
20109 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
20112 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
20113 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
20116 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
20117 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
20121 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
20124 (setq gnus-moderated-list
20125 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
20129 @node Image Enhancements
20130 @section Image Enhancements
20132 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21, is able to display pictures and stuff, so
20133 Gnus has taken advantage of that.
20136 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
20137 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
20138 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
20139 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
20140 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
20153 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
20154 good way to do so. Its also a great way to impress people staring
20155 over your shoulder as you read news.
20158 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
20159 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
20160 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
20161 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
20162 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
20167 @subsubsection Picon Basics
20169 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
20178 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
20179 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
20180 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
20181 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
20182 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
20183 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
20184 @code{GIF} formats.
20187 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
20188 If you have a permanent connection to the Internet you can use Steve
20189 Kinzler's Picons Search engine by setting
20190 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} to the string @*
20191 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/search.html}.
20193 @vindex gnus-picons-database
20194 Otherwise you need a local copy of his database. For instructions on
20195 obtaining and installing the picons databases, point your Web browser at @*
20196 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}. Gnus expects
20197 picons to be installed into a location pointed to by
20198 @code{gnus-picons-database}.
20200 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
20201 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
20204 @node Picon Requirements
20205 @subsubsection Picon Requirements
20207 To have Gnus display Picons for you, you must have @code{x} support
20208 compiled into XEmacs. To display color picons which are much nicer
20209 than the black & white one, you also need one of @code{xpm} or
20210 @code{gif} compiled into XEmacs.
20212 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
20213 If you want to display faces from @code{X-Face} headers, you should have
20214 the @code{xface} support compiled into XEmacs. Otherwise you must have
20215 the @code{netpbm} utilities installed, or munge the
20216 @code{gnus-picons-convert-x-face} variable to use something else.
20217 (NOTE: @code{x-face} is used in the variable name, not @code{xface})
20220 @subsubsection Easy Picons
20222 To enable displaying picons, simply put the following line in your
20223 @file{~/.gnus} file and start Gnus.
20226 (setq gnus-use-picons t)
20227 (setq gnus-treat-display-picons t)
20230 and make sure @code{gnus-picons-database} points to the directory
20231 containing the Picons databases.
20233 Alternatively if you want to use the web piconsearch engine add this:
20236 (setq gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
20237 "http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch")
20242 @subsubsection Hard Picons
20250 Gnus can display picons for you as you enter and leave groups and
20251 articles. It knows how to interact with three sections of the picons
20252 database. Namely, it can display the picons newsgroup pictures,
20253 author's face picture(s), and the authors domain. To enable this
20254 feature, you need to select where to get the picons from, and where to
20259 @item gnus-picons-database
20260 @vindex gnus-picons-database
20261 The location of the picons database. Should point to a directory
20262 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
20263 subdirectories. This is only useful if
20264 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} is @code{nil}. Defaults to
20265 @file{/usr/local/faces/}.
20267 @item gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
20268 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
20269 The URL for the web picons search engine. The only currently known
20270 engine is @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch}. To
20271 workaround network delays, icons will be fetched in the background. If
20272 this is @code{nil} 'the default), then picons are fetched from local
20273 database indicated by @code{gnus-picons-database}.
20275 @item gnus-picons-display-where
20276 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
20277 Where the picon images should be displayed. It is @code{picons} by
20278 default (which by default maps to the buffer @samp{*Picons*}). Other
20279 valid places could be @code{article}, @code{summary}, or
20280 @samp{*scratch*} for all I care. Just make sure that you've made the
20281 buffer visible using the standard Gnus window configuration
20282 routines---@pxref{Window Layout}.
20284 @item gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
20285 @vindex gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
20286 Groups that are matched by this regexp won't have their group icons
20291 Note: If you set @code{gnus-use-picons} to @code{t}, it will set up your
20292 window configuration for you to include the @code{picons} buffer.
20294 Now that you've made those decision, you need to add the following
20295 functions to the appropriate hooks so these pictures will get displayed
20298 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
20300 @item gnus-article-display-picons
20301 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
20302 Looks up and displays the picons for the author and the author's domain
20303 in the @code{gnus-picons-display-where} buffer.
20305 @item gnus-picons-article-display-x-face
20306 @findex gnus-picons-article-display-x-face
20307 Decodes and displays the X-Face header if present.
20308 (NOTE: @code{x-face} is used in the function name, not @code{xface})
20314 @node Picon Useless Configuration
20315 @subsubsection Picon Useless Configuration
20323 The following variables offer further control over how things are
20324 done, where things are located, and other useless stuff you really
20325 don't need to worry about.
20329 @item gnus-picons-news-directories
20330 @vindex gnus-picons-news-directories
20331 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
20332 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
20334 @item gnus-picons-user-directories
20335 @vindex gnus-picons-user-directories
20336 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for user
20337 faces. @code{("local" "users" "usenix" "misc")} is the default.
20339 @item gnus-picons-domain-directories
20340 @vindex gnus-picons-domain-directories
20341 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
20342 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
20343 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
20345 @item gnus-picons-convert-x-face
20346 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
20347 If you don't have @code{xface} support builtin XEmacs, this is the
20348 command to use to convert the @code{X-Face} header to an X bitmap
20349 (@code{xbm}). Defaults to @code{(format "@{ echo '/* Width=48,
20350 Height=48 */'; uncompface; @} | icontopbm | pbmtoxbm > %s"
20351 gnus-picons-x-face-file-name)}
20352 (NOTE: @code{x-face} is used in the variable name, not @code{xface})
20354 @item gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
20355 @vindex gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
20356 Names a temporary file to store the @code{X-Face} bitmap in. Defaults
20357 to @code{(format "/tmp/picon-xface.%s.xbm" (user-login-name))}.
20358 (NOTE: @code{x-face} is used in the variable name, not @code{xface})
20360 @item gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
20361 @vindex gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
20362 If you have set @code{gnus-picons-display-where} to @code{picons}, your
20363 XEmacs frame will become really cluttered. To alleviate this a bit you
20364 can set @code{gnus-picons-has-modeline-p} to @code{nil}; this will
20365 remove the mode line from the Picons buffer. This is only useful if
20366 @code{gnus-picons-display-where} is @code{picons}.
20368 @item gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
20369 @vindex gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
20370 If non-nil, display the article buffer before computing the picons.
20371 Defaults to @code{nil}.
20373 @item gnus-picons-display-as-address
20374 @vindex gnus-picons-display-as-address
20375 If @code{t} display textual email addresses along with pictures.
20376 Defaults to @code{t}.
20378 @item gnus-picons-file-suffixes
20379 @vindex gnus-picons-file-suffixes
20380 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
20381 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not builtin your XEmacs.
20383 @item gnus-picons-setup-hook
20384 @vindex gnus-picons-setup-hook
20385 Hook run in the picon buffer, if that is displayed.
20387 @item gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
20388 @vindex gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
20389 Whether to move point to first empty line when displaying picons. This
20390 has only an effect if `gnus-picons-display-where' has value `article'.
20392 If @code{nil}, display the picons in the @code{From} and
20393 @code{Newsgroups} lines. This is the default.
20395 @item gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
20396 @vindex gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
20397 Whether to clear the picons cache when exiting gnus. Gnus caches every
20398 picons it finds while it is running. This saves some time in the search
20399 process but eats some memory. If this variable is set to @code{nil},
20400 Gnus will never clear the cache itself; you will have to manually call
20401 @code{gnus-picons-clear-cache} to clear it. Otherwise the cache will be
20402 cleared every time you exit Gnus. Defaults to @code{t}.
20413 @subsection Smileys
20418 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
20423 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
20424 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
20426 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
20427 @file{.gnus.el} file:
20430 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
20433 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{:-=}, @samp{:-(} and
20434 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
20435 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
20436 text and maps that to file names.
20438 @vindex smiley-nosey-regexp-alist
20439 @vindex smiley-deformed-regexp-alist
20440 Smiley supplies two example conversion alists by default:
20441 @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist} (which matches @samp{:)}, @samp{:(}
20442 and so on), and @code{smiley-nosey-regexp-alist} (which matches
20443 @samp{:-)}, @samp{:-(} and so on).
20445 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist} variable,
20446 which defaults to the value of @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist}.
20448 The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched; the second
20449 element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by the picture;
20450 and the third element is the name of the file to be displayed.
20452 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
20453 files, as well as the color to be used and stuff:
20457 @item smiley-data-directory
20458 @vindex smiley-data-directory
20459 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
20461 @item smiley-flesh-color
20462 @vindex smiley-flesh-color
20463 Skin color. The default is @samp{yellow}, which is really racist.
20465 @item smiley-features-color
20466 @vindex smiley-features-color
20467 Color of the features of the face. The default is @samp{black}.
20469 @item smiley-tongue-color
20470 @vindex smiley-tongue-color
20471 Color of the tongue. The default is @samp{red}.
20473 @item smiley-circle-color
20474 @vindex smiley-circle-color
20475 Color of the circle around the face. The default is @samp{black}.
20477 @item smiley-mouse-face
20478 @vindex smiley-mouse-face
20479 Face used for mouse highlighting over the smiley face.
20488 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
20489 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
20490 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
20494 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
20495 @findex gnus-article-x-face-command
20496 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
20497 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
20505 Decoding an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
20506 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
20507 have @samp{compface} installed on your system. If either is true,
20508 Gnus will default to displaying @code{X-Face} headers.
20510 The variable that controls this is the
20511 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
20512 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
20513 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
20514 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
20515 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
20517 The default action under Emacs 20 is to fork off the @code{display}
20518 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For
20519 the @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
20520 like @code{compface} or @code{faces-xface} on a GNU/Linux system.} to
20523 Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image support, the default
20524 action is to display the face before the @code{From} header. (It's
20525 nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support---that
20526 will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native @code{X-Face}
20527 support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
20528 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
20529 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
20530 like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.})
20532 (NOTE: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
20535 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
20536 easier insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages.
20538 @findex gnus-random-x-face
20539 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files
20540 in @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
20541 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
20542 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
20543 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big.
20545 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a file as the parameter, and then
20546 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
20547 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
20549 Here's how you would typically use the former function. Put something
20550 like the folllowing in your @file{.gnus.el} file:
20553 (setq message-required-news-headers
20554 (nconc message-required-news-headers
20555 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
20558 Using the latter function would be something like this:
20561 (setq message-required-news-headers
20562 (nconc message-required-news-headers
20563 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
20564 (gnus-x-face-from-file
20565 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
20570 @subsection Toolbar
20580 @item gnus-use-toolbar
20581 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
20582 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
20583 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
20584 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
20586 @item gnus-group-toolbar
20587 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
20588 The toolbar in the group buffer.
20590 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
20591 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
20592 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
20594 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
20595 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
20596 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
20602 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
20605 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
20606 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
20607 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
20608 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
20609 unusual directory structure.
20611 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
20612 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
20613 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
20614 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
20616 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
20617 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
20618 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
20619 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
20620 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
20621 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
20623 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
20624 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
20625 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
20639 @node Fuzzy Matching
20640 @section Fuzzy Matching
20641 @cindex fuzzy matching
20643 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
20644 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
20646 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
20647 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
20648 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
20650 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
20651 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
20652 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
20653 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
20654 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
20657 @node Thwarting Email Spam
20658 @section Thwarting Email Spam
20662 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
20664 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
20665 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
20666 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
20667 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
20668 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
20669 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
20670 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
20671 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
20674 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
20675 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
20676 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
20677 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
20678 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
20679 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
20684 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
20685 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
20686 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
20689 @node Anti-Spam Basics
20690 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
20694 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
20696 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
20697 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
20699 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
20700 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
20701 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
20702 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
20703 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
20704 part of the mail address.)
20707 (setq message-default-news-headers
20708 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
20711 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
20712 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
20717 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
20718 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
20719 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
20725 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
20726 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
20727 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
20728 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
20730 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @sc{smtp} server
20731 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
20732 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
20733 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
20734 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
20735 your fancy split rule in this way:
20740 (to "larsi" "misc")
20744 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
20745 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
20746 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
20747 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
20748 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
20750 If you are also a lazy net citizen, you will probably prefer complaining
20751 automatically with the @file{gnus-junk.el} package, available FOR FREE
20752 at @* @uref{http://stud2.tuwien.ac.at/~e9426626/gnus-junk.html}.
20753 Since most e-mail spam is sent automatically, this may reconcile the
20754 cosmic balance somewhat.
20756 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
20757 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
20758 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
20759 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
20764 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
20765 @cindex SpamAssassin
20766 @cindex Vipul's Razor
20769 The days where the hints in the previous section was sufficient in
20770 avoiding spam is coming to an end. There are many tools out there
20771 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
20772 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
20773 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
20774 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
20775 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
20777 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
20778 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
20779 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
20780 Specifiers}) follows.
20784 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
20787 :postscript "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
20790 Once you managed to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
20791 the mail contain e.g. a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
20792 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
20795 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
20799 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
20802 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
20803 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
20807 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
20808 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
20809 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
20810 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
20813 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
20815 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
20817 (let ((buf (or (get-buffer " *nnmail incoming*")
20818 (get-buffer " *nnml move*"))))
20820 (progn (message "Oops, cannot find message buffer") nil)
20822 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
20823 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
20827 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
20828 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
20829 spam. And here is the nifty function:
20832 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
20833 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
20835 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
20836 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
20837 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
20841 @subsection Hashcash
20844 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
20845 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
20846 you cannot rely on that everyone in the world uses this technique,
20847 since it is not part of the internet standards, but it may be useful
20848 in smaller communities.
20850 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
20851 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
20852 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
20853 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
20854 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
20855 instead requires that everyone you communicate with supports the
20856 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
20857 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
20858 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
20859 one of them separately.
20862 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
20863 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
20864 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
20865 header. For more details, and for the external application
20866 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
20867 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
20868 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
20870 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
20874 (require 'hashcash)
20875 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
20878 The @code{hashcash.el} library can be found at
20879 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}, or in the Gnus
20880 development contrib directory.
20882 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
20886 @item hashcash-default-payment
20887 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
20888 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
20889 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
20890 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
20892 @item hashcash-payment-alist
20893 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
20894 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
20895 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(ADDR AMOUNT)} cells,
20896 where ADDR is the receiver (email address or newsgroup) and AMOUNT is
20897 the number of bits in the collision that is needed. It can also
20898 contain @samp{(ADDR STRING AMOUNT)} cells, where the STRING is the
20899 string to use (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
20903 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
20907 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
20908 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
20909 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
20910 a useful contribution, however.
20912 @node Various Various
20913 @section Various Various
20919 @item gnus-home-directory
20920 All Gnus path variables will be initialized from this variable, which
20921 defaults to @file{~/}.
20923 @item gnus-directory
20924 @vindex gnus-directory
20925 Most Gnus storage path variables will be initialized from this variable,
20926 which defaults to the @samp{SAVEDIR} environment variable, or
20927 @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
20929 Note that gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{.gnus.el} file is read.
20930 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
20931 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
20932 @file{.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
20934 @item gnus-default-directory
20935 @vindex gnus-default-directory
20936 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
20937 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
20938 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
20939 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
20940 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
20941 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
20944 @vindex gnus-verbose
20945 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
20946 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
20947 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
20948 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
20949 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
20951 @item gnus-verbose-backends
20952 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
20953 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
20954 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
20956 @item nnheader-max-head-length
20957 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
20958 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
20959 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
20960 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
20961 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
20962 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
20963 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
20964 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
20965 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
20967 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
20968 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
20969 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
20970 read when doing the operation described above.
20972 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
20973 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
20975 @cindex invalid characters in file names
20976 @cindex characters in file names
20977 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
20978 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
20979 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
20982 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
20986 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
20987 Windows (phooey) systems.
20989 @item gnus-hidden-properties
20990 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
20991 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
20992 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
20993 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
20995 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
20996 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
20997 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
20998 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
20999 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
21001 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
21002 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
21003 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
21005 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
21006 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
21008 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
21009 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
21010 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
21011 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
21014 @sc{imap} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
21022 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
21023 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
21025 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
21027 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
21033 Not because of victories @*
21036 but for the common sunshine,@*
21038 the largess of the spring.
21042 but for the day's work done@*
21043 as well as I was able;@*
21044 not for a seat upon the dais@*
21045 but at the common table.@*
21050 @chapter Appendices
21053 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
21054 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
21055 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
21056 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
21057 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
21058 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
21059 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
21060 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
21061 * Frequently Asked Questions::
21068 @cindex Installing under XEmacs
21070 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
21071 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
21072 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{w3}, @samp{mh-e},
21073 @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{rmail}, @samp{eterm}, @samp{mail-lib},
21074 @samp{xemacs-base}, and @samp{fsf-compat}.
21081 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
21082 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
21084 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
21085 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
21086 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
21087 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
21088 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
21090 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
21091 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
21092 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
21093 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
21094 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
21095 appropriate name, don't you think?)
21097 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
21098 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
21099 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
21100 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
21103 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
21104 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
21105 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
21106 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
21107 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
21108 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
21109 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
21110 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
21111 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
21115 @node Gnus Versions
21116 @subsection Gnus Versions
21118 @cindex September Gnus
21120 @cindex Quassia Gnus
21121 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
21125 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
21126 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
21127 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
21129 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
21130 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
21132 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
21133 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
21135 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
21136 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
21138 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
21139 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
21142 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun.
21144 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
21145 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
21146 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'' -- don't panic. Don't let it know
21147 that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever you do, don't
21148 run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach. Find a proper
21149 released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
21152 @node Other Gnus Versions
21153 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
21156 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
21157 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
21158 Japan. It's based on a library called @sc{semi}, which provides
21159 @sc{mime} capabilities.
21161 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
21162 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
21163 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
21164 @sc{mime} and multilingualization things, especially important for
21171 What's the point of Gnus?
21173 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
21174 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
21175 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
21176 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
21177 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
21178 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
21179 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
21180 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
21181 keep track of millions of people who post?
21183 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
21184 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
21185 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
21186 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
21187 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
21188 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
21189 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
21190 every one of you to explore and invent.
21192 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
21193 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
21196 @node Compatibility
21197 @subsection Compatibility
21199 @cindex compatibility
21200 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
21201 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
21202 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
21207 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
21211 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
21214 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
21217 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
21218 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
21219 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
21220 important variables have their values copied into their global
21221 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
21222 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
21224 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
21225 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
21226 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
21227 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
21228 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
21232 @cindex highlighting
21233 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
21234 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
21235 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
21236 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
21237 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
21238 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
21241 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
21242 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
21243 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
21244 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
21246 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
21247 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
21248 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
21249 to stop doing it the old way.
21251 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
21253 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
21255 @cindex reporting bugs
21257 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
21258 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
21259 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
21261 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
21262 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
21263 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
21264 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
21269 @subsection Conformity
21271 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
21272 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
21280 There are no known breaches of this standard.
21284 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
21286 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
21287 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
21288 We do have some breaches to this one.
21294 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
21295 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
21296 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
21297 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
21298 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
21303 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
21304 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
21305 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
21306 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
21308 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
21310 All the various @sc{mime} RFCs are supported.
21312 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
21313 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
21315 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
21318 RFC 1991 is the original PGP message specification, published as a
21319 Information RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now called Open PGP, and
21320 put on the Standards Track. Both document a non-@sc{mime} aware PGP
21321 format. Gnus supports both encoding (signing and encryption) and
21322 decoding (verification and decryption).
21324 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
21325 RFC 2015 (superceded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
21326 1991) describes the @sc{mime}-wrapping around the RF 1991/2440 format.
21327 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
21329 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
21330 RFC 2633 describes the @sc{s/mime} format.
21332 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
21333 RFC 1730 is @sc{imap} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060 (@sc{imap} 4
21334 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5 authentication for @sc{imap}. RFC
21335 2086 describes access control lists (ACLs) for @sc{imap}. RFC 2359
21336 describes a @sc{imap} protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper
21337 TLS integration (STARTTLS) with @sc{imap}. RFC 1731 describes the
21338 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @sc{imap}.
21342 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
21343 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
21348 @subsection Emacsen
21354 Gnus should work on :
21362 XEmacs 21.1.1 and up.
21366 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
21367 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
21368 Emacs versions. However, T-gnus does support ``Mule 2.3 based on Emacs
21369 19.34'' and possibly the versions of XEmacs prior to 21.1.1, e.g. 20.4.
21370 See the file ``README'' in the T-gnus distribution for more details.
21372 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
21373 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
21374 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
21378 @node Gnus Development
21379 @subsection Gnus Development
21381 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
21382 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
21383 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
21384 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
21385 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
21386 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
21387 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
21388 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
21390 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
21391 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
21392 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
21393 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
21394 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
21397 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
21398 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
21399 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
21400 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
21401 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
21403 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
21404 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
21405 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
21406 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
21407 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
21408 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
21409 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
21410 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
21411 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
21412 can't be assumed to do so.
21417 @subsection Contributors
21418 @cindex contributors
21420 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
21421 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
21422 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
21423 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
21424 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
21425 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
21426 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
21427 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
21428 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
21429 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
21431 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for... oops,
21437 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
21440 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
21441 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @sc{mime} and
21442 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
21443 functionality and stuff.
21446 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
21447 well as numerous other things).
21450 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
21453 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
21456 Justin Sheehy--the FAQ maintainer.
21459 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
21462 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
21463 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
21466 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
21469 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
21470 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
21473 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
21476 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
21479 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
21482 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
21485 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
21486 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
21489 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
21492 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
21495 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
21498 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
21502 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
21505 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
21508 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
21511 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
21512 well as autoconf support.
21516 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
21517 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
21519 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
21528 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
21532 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
21542 Alexei V. Barantsev,
21557 Massimo Campostrini,
21562 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
21563 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
21567 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
21570 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
21576 Michael Welsh Duggan,
21581 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
21585 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
21593 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
21595 Michelangelo Grigni,
21599 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
21601 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c ?
21603 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
21610 François Felix Ingrand,
21611 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c ?
21612 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
21614 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
21625 Peter Skov Knudsen,
21626 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
21628 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
21629 Thor Kristoffersen,
21632 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
21650 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
21651 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
21658 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
21663 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
21667 John McClary Prevost,
21673 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
21678 Christian von Roques,
21681 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
21688 Philippe Schnoebelen,
21690 Randal L. Schwartz,
21704 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
21709 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
21725 Katsumi Yamaoka @c Yamaoka
21730 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
21731 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
21732 (550kB and counting).
21734 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
21737 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
21738 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
21742 @subsection New Features
21743 @cindex new features
21746 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
21747 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
21748 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
21749 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
21750 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
21753 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
21754 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
21755 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
21758 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
21760 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
21765 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
21766 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
21769 Local spool and several @sc{nntp} servers can be used at once
21770 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
21773 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
21776 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
21777 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
21778 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
21781 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
21782 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
21783 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
21784 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
21787 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
21788 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
21791 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
21792 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
21793 (@pxref{The Active File}).
21796 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
21797 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
21800 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
21801 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
21802 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
21805 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
21806 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
21807 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
21810 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{.gnus}) to avoid cluttering up
21811 the @file{.emacs} file.
21814 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
21815 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
21818 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
21819 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
21822 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
21823 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
21826 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
21827 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
21830 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
21831 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
21834 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
21837 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
21838 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
21841 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
21842 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
21845 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
21846 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
21849 Gnus can fetch FAQs and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
21852 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
21853 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
21856 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
21860 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
21864 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
21865 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
21868 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
21874 @node September Gnus
21875 @subsubsection September Gnus
21879 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
21883 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
21888 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
21889 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
21893 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
21894 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
21898 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
21902 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
21903 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
21906 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
21910 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
21913 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
21916 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
21919 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
21923 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
21924 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
21927 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
21931 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
21935 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
21939 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
21943 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
21946 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
21947 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
21950 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
21954 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
21955 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
21958 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
21961 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
21962 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
21963 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
21966 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
21970 The Gnus cache is much faster.
21973 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
21977 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
21978 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
21981 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
21982 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
21985 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
21986 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
21989 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
21990 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
21991 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
21994 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
21995 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
21998 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
22001 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
22004 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
22007 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
22010 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
22011 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
22014 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
22018 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
22021 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
22026 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
22029 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
22033 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
22036 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
22040 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
22043 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
22046 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
22047 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
22050 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
22051 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
22055 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
22056 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
22059 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
22063 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
22064 buffer to allow easier treatment.
22067 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
22070 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
22074 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
22078 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
22079 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
22082 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
22086 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
22087 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
22090 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
22091 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
22094 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
22098 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
22101 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
22104 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
22110 @subsubsection Red Gnus
22112 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
22116 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
22123 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
22126 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
22127 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
22130 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
22131 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
22135 Article washing status can be displayed in the
22136 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
22139 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
22142 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
22143 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
22146 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
22150 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
22151 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
22155 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
22156 Server Internals}).
22159 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
22163 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
22166 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
22167 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
22170 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
22171 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
22172 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
22175 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
22176 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
22179 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
22180 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
22183 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
22187 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
22188 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
22191 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
22192 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
22195 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
22199 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
22202 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
22206 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
22207 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
22210 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
22211 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
22214 A new command for reading collections of documents
22215 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
22216 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
22219 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
22223 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @sc{nntp}
22224 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
22227 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
22228 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
22229 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
22232 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
22233 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
22237 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
22241 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
22245 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
22250 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
22254 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
22258 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
22259 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
22262 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
22268 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
22270 New features in Gnus 5.6:
22275 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
22276 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See
22277 @pxref{Gnus Unplugged} for the full story.
22280 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
22281 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
22282 group, which is created automatically.
22285 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
22289 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
22292 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
22293 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
22296 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
22300 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
22303 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
22304 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
22307 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
22310 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
22311 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
22314 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
22315 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
22318 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
22319 control over simplification.
22322 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
22325 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
22329 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
22332 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
22335 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
22336 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
22337 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
22340 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
22341 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
22344 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
22348 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
22349 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
22352 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
22353 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @sc{nntp} servers.
22356 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
22360 A history of where mails have been split is available.
22363 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
22366 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
22367 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
22370 A new function for citing in Message has been
22371 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
22374 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
22377 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
22381 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
22382 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
22385 The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
22386 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
22389 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
22392 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
22396 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
22397 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
22399 New features in Gnus 5.8:
22404 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
22405 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
22407 If you used procmail like in
22410 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
22411 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
22412 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
22413 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
22416 this now has changed to
22420 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
22424 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
22425 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
22428 Gnus is now a @sc{mime}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
22429 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
22432 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
22433 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
22436 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
22437 called to position point.
22440 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
22441 summary buffers and @sc{nov} files.
22444 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
22445 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
22448 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
22449 subtly different manner.
22452 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
22453 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
22454 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
22457 Gnus can now read @sc{imap} mail via @code{nnimap}.
22465 @section The Manual
22469 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
22470 either @code{texi2dvi}
22472 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
22473 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
22475 to get what you hold in your hands now.
22477 The following conventions have been used:
22482 This is a @samp{string}
22485 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
22488 This is a @file{file}
22491 This is a @code{symbol}
22495 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
22499 (setq flargnoze "yes")
22502 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
22505 (setq flumphel 'yes)
22508 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
22509 ever get them confused.
22513 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
22514 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
22515 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
22516 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
22517 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
22518 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
22519 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
22525 @node On Writing Manuals
22526 @section On Writing Manuals
22528 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
22529 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
22530 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
22531 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
22532 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
22533 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
22536 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
22537 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
22538 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
22541 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
22542 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
22547 @section Terminology
22549 @cindex terminology
22554 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
22555 News is generally fetched from a nearby @sc{nntp} server, and is
22556 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
22557 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
22558 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
22562 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
22563 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
22564 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
22565 not posting, and replying is not following up.
22569 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
22573 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
22578 Gnus gets fed articles from a number of back ends, both news and mail
22579 back ends. Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this
22580 is all done by the back ends.
22584 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
22585 default, way of getting news.
22589 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
22590 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
22595 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
22596 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
22600 A message that has been posted as news.
22603 @cindex mail message
22604 A message that has been mailed.
22608 A mail message or news article
22612 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
22617 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
22622 A line from the head of an article.
22626 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
22627 collection of @sc{nov} lines.
22631 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
22632 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
22633 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
22634 normal @sc{head} format.
22638 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
22639 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
22640 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
22641 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
22642 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
22643 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
22645 @item killed groups
22646 @cindex killed groups
22647 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
22648 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
22650 @item zombie groups
22651 @cindex zombie groups
22652 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
22655 @cindex active file
22656 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
22657 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
22658 is rather large, as you might surmise.
22661 @cindex bogus groups
22662 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
22663 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
22664 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
22667 @cindex activating groups
22668 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
22669 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
22670 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
22674 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
22676 @item select method
22677 @cindex select method
22678 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
22681 @item virtual server
22682 @cindex virtual server
22683 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
22684 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
22685 whole is a virtual server.
22689 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
22690 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
22693 @item ephemeral groups
22694 @cindex ephemeral groups
22695 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
22696 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
22697 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
22700 @cindex solid groups
22701 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
22702 group buffer are solid groups.
22704 @item sparse articles
22705 @cindex sparse articles
22706 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
22707 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
22711 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
22712 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
22716 @cindex thread root
22717 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
22718 articles in the thread.
22722 An article that has responses.
22726 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
22730 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
22731 specified by RFC 1153.
22737 @node Customization
22738 @section Customization
22739 @cindex general customization
22741 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
22742 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
22743 for some quite common situations.
22746 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
22747 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
22748 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
22749 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
22753 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
22754 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
22756 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
22757 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
22758 Gnus has to get from the @sc{nntp} server.
22762 @item gnus-read-active-file
22763 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
22764 entire active file from the server. This file is often v. large. You
22765 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
22766 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
22767 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
22769 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
22770 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
22771 the @sc{nntp} server will not be very fast. Not all @sc{nntp} servers
22772 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
22776 @node Slow Terminal Connection
22777 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
22779 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
22780 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
22781 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
22785 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
22786 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
22787 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
22788 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
22789 horizontal and vertical recentering.
22791 @item gnus-visible-headers
22792 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
22793 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
22794 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
22795 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
22797 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
22799 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
22800 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
22801 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
22804 @item gnus-use-full-window
22805 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
22806 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
22807 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
22808 want to read them anyway.
22810 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
22811 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
22815 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
22816 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
22817 lines, which might save some time.
22821 @node Little Disk Space
22822 @subsection Little Disk Space
22825 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
22826 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
22830 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
22831 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
22832 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
22833 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
22836 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
22837 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
22838 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
22839 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
22842 @item gnus-save-killed-list
22843 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
22844 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
22845 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
22846 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
22852 @subsection Slow Machine
22853 @cindex slow machine
22855 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
22856 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
22858 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
22859 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
22861 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
22862 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
22863 summary buffer faster.
22867 @node Troubleshooting
22868 @section Troubleshooting
22869 @cindex troubleshooting
22871 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
22879 Make sure your computer is switched on.
22882 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
22883 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
22887 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
22888 like @samp{T-gnus 6.15.* (based on Oort Gnus v0.*; for SEMI 1.1*, FLIM
22889 1.1*)} you have the right files loaded. If, on the other hand, you get
22890 something like @samp{NNTP 3.x} or @samp{nntp flee}, you have some old
22891 @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
22894 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a FAQ and a
22898 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
22899 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
22900 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
22901 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
22902 something like that.
22905 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
22908 @cindex reporting bugs
22910 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
22912 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
22913 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
22914 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
22915 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
22917 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
22918 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
22919 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
22920 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
22923 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
22924 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
22925 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
22926 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
22927 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
22928 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
22930 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
22931 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
22932 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
22936 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
22937 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
22939 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
22940 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful.
22942 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
22943 @cindex ding mailing list
22944 You can also ask on the ding mailing list---@samp{ding@@gnus.org}.
22945 Write to @samp{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
22949 @node Gnus Reference Guide
22950 @section Gnus Reference Guide
22952 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
22953 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
22954 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
22955 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
22958 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
22959 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
22960 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
22961 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
22962 and general methods of operation.
22965 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
22966 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
22967 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
22968 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
22969 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
22970 * Group Info:: The group info format.
22971 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
22972 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
22973 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
22977 @node Gnus Utility Functions
22978 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
22979 @cindex Gnus utility functions
22980 @cindex utility functions
22982 @cindex internal variables
22984 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
22985 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
22986 Below is a list of the most common ones.
22990 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
22991 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
22992 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
22994 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
22995 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
22996 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
22998 @item gnus-group-real-name
22999 @findex gnus-group-real-name
23000 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
23003 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
23004 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
23005 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
23006 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
23008 @item gnus-get-info
23009 @findex gnus-get-info
23010 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
23012 @item gnus-group-unread
23013 @findex gnus-group-unread
23014 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
23018 @findex gnus-active
23019 The active entry for @var{group}.
23021 @item gnus-set-active
23022 @findex gnus-set-active
23023 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
23025 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
23026 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
23027 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
23030 @item gnus-continuum-version
23031 @findex gnus-continuum-version
23032 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
23033 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
23036 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
23037 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
23038 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
23040 @item gnus-news-group-p
23041 @findex gnus-news-group-p
23042 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
23044 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
23045 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
23046 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
23048 @item gnus-server-to-method
23049 @findex gnus-server-to-method
23050 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
23052 @item gnus-server-equal
23053 @findex gnus-server-equal
23054 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
23056 @item gnus-group-native-p
23057 @findex gnus-group-native-p
23058 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
23060 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
23061 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
23062 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
23064 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
23065 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
23066 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
23068 @item group-group-find-parameter
23069 @findex group-group-find-parameter
23070 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
23071 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
23073 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
23074 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
23075 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
23077 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
23078 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
23079 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
23081 @item gnus-check-backend-function
23082 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
23083 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
23084 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
23087 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
23091 @item gnus-read-method
23092 @findex gnus-read-method
23093 Prompts the user for a select method.
23098 @node Back End Interface
23099 @subsection Back End Interface
23101 Gnus doesn't know anything about @sc{nntp}, spools, mail or virtual
23102 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
23103 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
23104 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
23105 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
23106 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
23108 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
23109 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
23110 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
23111 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
23112 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
23113 been opened, the function should fail.
23115 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
23116 name. Take this example:
23120 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
23121 (nntp-port-number 4324))
23124 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
23125 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
23127 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
23128 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
23129 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
23131 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
23132 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
23133 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
23135 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
23136 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
23137 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
23138 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
23139 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
23140 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
23143 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
23144 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
23145 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
23146 -- they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
23149 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
23150 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
23151 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
23152 possible for later articles to `re-use' older article numbers without
23153 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
23154 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
23155 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
23156 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
23157 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
23158 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
23160 The previous paragraph already mentions all the `hard' restrictions that
23161 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
23162 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
23163 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
23164 the `no-reuse' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
23165 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
23166 of numbers as long as possible.
23168 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
23171 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
23174 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
23175 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
23176 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
23177 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
23178 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
23179 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
23183 @node Required Back End Functions
23184 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
23188 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
23190 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
23191 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
23192 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
23193 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
23195 The result data should either be HEADs or @sc{nov} lines, and the result
23196 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
23197 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
23198 of HEADs and @sc{nov} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
23200 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching "extra
23201 headers", in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
23202 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
23203 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
23204 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
23205 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
23206 number, do maximum fetches.
23208 Here's an example HEAD:
23211 221 1056 Article retrieved.
23212 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
23213 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
23214 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
23215 Subject: Re: Something very droll
23216 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
23217 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
23219 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
23220 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
23221 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
23225 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
23226 these in the data buffer.
23228 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
23232 head = error / valid-head
23233 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
23234 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
23235 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
23236 header = <text> eol
23239 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
23240 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
23244 nov-buffer = *nov-line
23245 nov-line = 8*9 [ field <TAB> ] eol
23246 field = <text except TAB>
23249 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
23253 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
23255 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
23256 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
23258 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
23259 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
23260 server. In fact, it should do so.
23262 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
23263 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
23266 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
23268 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
23269 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
23272 There should be no data returned.
23275 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
23277 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
23278 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
23279 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
23280 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
23282 There should be no data returned.
23285 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
23287 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
23288 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
23289 non-@code{nil} vlue. This function should under no circumstances
23290 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
23292 There should be no data returned.
23295 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
23297 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
23299 There should be no data returned.
23302 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
23304 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
23305 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
23306 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
23307 it would be nice if that were possible.
23309 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
23310 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
23311 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
23312 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
23313 into its article buffer.
23315 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
23316 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
23317 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
23318 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
23319 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
23320 on successful article retrieval.
23323 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
23325 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
23326 making @var{group} the current group.
23328 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
23331 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
23334 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
23337 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
23338 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
23339 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
23340 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
23341 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
23342 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
23343 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
23344 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
23345 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
23349 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
23350 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
23351 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
23355 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
23357 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
23358 a no-op on most back ends.
23360 There should be no data returned.
23363 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
23365 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
23368 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
23371 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
23372 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
23375 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
23376 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
23377 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
23378 and the highest as 0.
23381 active-file = *active-line
23382 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
23384 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
23387 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
23388 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
23389 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
23392 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
23394 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
23395 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
23396 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
23397 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
23398 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
23399 clear if the posting could not be completed.
23401 There should be no result data from this function.
23406 @node Optional Back End Functions
23407 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
23411 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
23413 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
23414 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
23415 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
23417 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
23418 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
23419 former is in the same format as the data from
23420 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
23421 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
23424 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
23428 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
23430 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
23431 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all the
23432 information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
23433 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
23434 should return the (altered) group info.
23436 There should be no result data from this function.
23439 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
23441 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
23442 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
23443 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
23444 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
23445 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
23446 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
23447 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
23448 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
23450 There should be no result data from this function.
23453 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
23455 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
23456 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
23457 @code{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @sc{imap}) however carry
23458 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
23459 propagate the mark information to the server.
23461 ACTION is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
23464 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
23467 RANGE is a range of articles you wish to update marks on. ACTION is
23468 @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove marks
23469 (preserving all marks not mentioned). MARK is a list of marks; where
23470 each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are @code{read},
23471 @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
23472 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
23473 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
23474 possible, not limit itself to these.
23476 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
23477 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
23478 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
23479 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
23481 An example action list:
23484 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
23485 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
23486 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
23489 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
23490 mark on (currently not used for anything).
23492 There should be no result data from this function.
23494 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
23496 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
23497 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
23498 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
23499 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
23500 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
23502 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
23503 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
23504 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
23507 There should be no result data from this function.
23510 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
23512 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
23513 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
23514 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query the
23515 POP server when this function is invoked. The @var{group} doesn't have
23516 to be heeded---if the back end decides that it is too much work just
23517 scanning for a single group, it may do a total scan of all groups. It
23518 would be nice, however, to keep things local if that's practical.
23520 There should be no result data from this function.
23523 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
23525 The result data from this function should be a description of
23529 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
23531 description = <text>
23534 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
23536 The result data from this function should be the description of all
23537 groups available on the server.
23540 description-buffer = *description-line
23544 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
23546 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
23547 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
23548 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
23549 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
23550 in the active buffer format.
23552 It is okay for this function to return `too many' groups; some back ends
23553 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
23554 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
23555 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
23556 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
23557 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
23558 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
23561 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
23563 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
23565 There should be no return data.
23568 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
23570 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
23571 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
23572 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
23573 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
23574 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
23577 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
23580 There should be no result data returned.
23583 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM
23586 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
23587 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
23589 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
23590 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
23591 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
23592 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
23593 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
23594 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
23596 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
23597 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
23600 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
23601 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
23603 There should be no data returned.
23606 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
23608 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
23609 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
23610 this function in short order.
23612 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
23613 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
23615 There should be no data returned.
23618 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
23620 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
23621 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
23623 There should be no data returned.
23626 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
23628 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
23629 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
23630 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
23632 There should be no data returned.
23635 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
23637 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
23638 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
23640 There should be no data returned.
23645 @node Error Messaging
23646 @subsubsection Error Messaging
23648 @findex nnheader-report
23649 @findex nnheader-get-report
23650 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
23651 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
23652 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
23653 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
23654 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
23655 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
23658 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
23660 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
23663 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
23664 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
23665 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
23666 takes one argument---the server symbol.
23668 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
23669 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
23670 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
23673 @node Writing New Back Ends
23674 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
23676 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
23677 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
23678 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
23679 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
23680 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
23683 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
23684 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
23685 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
23687 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
23688 package called @code{nnoo}.
23690 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
23691 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
23697 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
23698 parameters. For instance:
23701 (nnoo-declare nndir
23705 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
23706 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
23709 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
23710 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
23711 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
23713 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
23714 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
23715 a function in those back ends.
23718 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
23719 "Where nndir will look for groups."
23720 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
23723 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
23724 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
23725 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
23727 @item nnoo-define-basics
23728 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
23732 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
23736 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
23737 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
23738 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
23740 @item nnoo-map-functions
23741 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
23742 functions from the parent back ends.
23745 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
23746 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
23747 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
23750 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
23751 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
23752 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
23753 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
23756 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
23757 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
23758 haven't already been defined.
23764 nnmh-request-newgroups)
23768 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
23769 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
23770 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
23775 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
23778 ;;; nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus
23779 ;; Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
23783 (require 'nnheader)
23787 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
23789 (nnoo-declare nndir
23792 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
23793 "Where nndir will look for groups."
23794 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
23796 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
23797 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
23800 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
23802 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
23803 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
23804 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
23806 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
23807 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
23809 ;;; Interface functions.
23811 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
23813 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
23814 (setq nndir-directory
23815 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
23817 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
23818 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
23819 (push `(nndir-current-group
23820 ,(file-name-nondirectory
23821 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
23823 (push `(nndir-top-directory
23824 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
23826 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
23828 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
23829 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
23830 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
23831 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
23832 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
23836 nnmh-status-message
23838 nnmh-request-newgroups))
23844 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
23845 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
23847 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
23848 @findex gnus-declare-backend
23849 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
23850 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
23851 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
23853 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
23854 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
23859 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
23862 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
23864 The abilities can be:
23868 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
23870 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
23872 This back end supports both mail and news.
23874 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
23877 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
23878 articles and groups.
23880 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
23881 true for almost all back ends.
23882 @item prompt-address
23883 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
23884 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
23885 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
23889 @node Mail-like Back Ends
23890 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
23892 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
23893 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
23894 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
23895 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
23898 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
23899 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
23900 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
23903 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
23904 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
23907 This function takes four parameters.
23911 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
23914 @item exit-function
23915 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
23917 @item temp-directory
23918 Where the temporary files should be stored.
23921 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
23922 performed for one group only.
23925 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
23926 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
23927 find the article number assigned to this article.
23929 The function also uses the following variables:
23930 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
23931 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
23932 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
23933 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
23937 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
23938 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
23942 @node Score File Syntax
23943 @subsection Score File Syntax
23945 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
23946 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
23947 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
23949 Here's a typical score file:
23953 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
23960 BNF definition of a score file:
23963 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
23964 element = rule / atom
23965 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
23966 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
23967 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
23968 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
23970 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
23971 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
23972 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
23973 date-header = "date"
23974 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
23975 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
23976 score = "nil" / <integer>
23977 date = "nil" / <natural number>
23978 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
23979 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
23980 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
23981 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
23982 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
23983 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
23984 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
23985 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
23986 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
23987 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
23988 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
23989 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
23990 exclude-files / read-only / touched
23991 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
23992 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
23993 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
23994 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
23995 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
23996 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
23997 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
23998 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
23999 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
24000 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
24001 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
24002 eval = "eval" space <form>
24003 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
24006 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
24009 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
24010 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
24011 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
24012 one looong line, then that's ok.
24014 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
24015 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
24019 @subsection Headers
24021 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
24022 corresponds to the @sc{nov} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
24023 almost suspect that the author looked at the @sc{nov} specification and
24024 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
24026 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
24027 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
24028 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
24029 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
24030 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
24031 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
24032 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
24034 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
24035 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
24036 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
24037 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
24038 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
24040 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
24041 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
24047 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
24048 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
24050 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
24051 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
24052 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
24053 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
24055 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
24059 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
24062 is transformed into
24065 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
24068 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
24069 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
24072 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
24075 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
24076 is slightly tricky:
24079 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
24085 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
24088 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
24094 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
24101 and is equal to the previous range.
24103 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
24104 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
24105 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
24109 range = simple-range / normal-range
24110 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
24111 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
24112 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
24113 number *[ " " contents ]
24116 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
24117 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
24118 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
24119 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
24120 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
24125 @subsection Group Info
24127 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
24128 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
24129 describes the group.
24131 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
24132 second is a more complex one:
24135 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
24137 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
24138 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
24140 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
24143 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
24144 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
24145 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
24146 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
24147 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
24148 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
24149 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
24150 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
24151 this section is about.
24153 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
24154 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
24155 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
24157 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
24160 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
24161 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
24162 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
24163 group = quote <string> quote
24164 ralevel = rank / level
24165 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
24166 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
24167 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
24169 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
24170 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
24171 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
24172 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
24175 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
24176 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
24179 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
24180 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
24183 @item gnus-info-group
24184 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
24185 @findex gnus-info-group
24186 @findex gnus-info-set-group
24187 Get/set the group name.
24189 @item gnus-info-rank
24190 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
24191 @findex gnus-info-rank
24192 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
24193 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
24195 @item gnus-info-level
24196 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
24197 @findex gnus-info-level
24198 @findex gnus-info-set-level
24199 Get/set the group level.
24201 @item gnus-info-score
24202 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
24203 @findex gnus-info-score
24204 @findex gnus-info-set-score
24205 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
24207 @item gnus-info-read
24208 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
24209 @findex gnus-info-read
24210 @findex gnus-info-set-read
24211 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
24213 @item gnus-info-marks
24214 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
24215 @findex gnus-info-marks
24216 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
24217 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
24219 @item gnus-info-method
24220 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
24221 @findex gnus-info-method
24222 @findex gnus-info-set-method
24223 Get/set the group select method.
24225 @item gnus-info-params
24226 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
24227 @findex gnus-info-params
24228 @findex gnus-info-set-params
24229 Get/set the group parameters.
24232 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
24233 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
24235 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
24236 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
24237 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
24238 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
24241 @node Extended Interactive
24242 @subsection Extended Interactive
24243 @cindex interactive
24244 @findex gnus-interactive
24246 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
24247 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
24248 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
24251 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
24252 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
24257 The best thing to do would have been to implement
24258 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
24259 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
24260 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
24261 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
24262 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
24263 @code{interactive}.
24265 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
24270 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
24271 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
24275 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
24276 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
24277 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
24280 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
24284 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
24288 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
24294 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
24295 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
24299 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
24300 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
24301 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
24303 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
24304 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
24305 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
24306 Gnus, that's very useful.
24308 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
24309 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
24310 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
24311 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
24312 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
24313 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
24314 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
24315 following function:
24318 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
24322 (,function ,@@args))
24326 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
24327 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
24328 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
24331 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
24332 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
24333 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
24335 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
24336 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
24337 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
24340 @node Various File Formats
24341 @subsection Various File Formats
24344 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
24345 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
24349 @node Active File Format
24350 @subsubsection Active File Format
24352 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
24353 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
24356 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
24359 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
24360 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
24361 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
24362 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
24363 no.general 1000 900 y
24366 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
24369 active = *group-line
24370 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
24371 group = <non-white-space string>
24373 high-number = <non-negative integer>
24374 low-number = <positive integer>
24375 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
24378 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
24379 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
24382 @node Newsgroups File Format
24383 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
24385 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
24386 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
24387 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
24390 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
24391 Here's the definition:
24395 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
24396 group = <non-white-space string>
24398 description = <string>
24403 @node Emacs for Heathens
24404 @section Emacs for Heathens
24406 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
24407 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
24408 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
24409 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
24410 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
24411 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
24412 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
24416 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
24417 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
24422 @subsection Keystrokes
24426 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
24429 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
24432 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
24433 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
24434 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
24435 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
24436 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
24437 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
24439 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
24440 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
24441 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
24442 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
24443 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
24444 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
24445 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
24447 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
24448 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
24449 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
24450 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
24451 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
24452 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
24453 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
24455 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
24456 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
24457 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
24458 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
24459 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
24465 @subsection Emacs Lisp
24467 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
24468 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
24469 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
24470 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
24472 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
24473 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
24474 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
24475 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
24476 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
24477 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
24478 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
24481 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
24482 write the following:
24485 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
24488 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
24489 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
24490 you can go and fill your @code{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
24493 If you have put that thing in your @code{.emacs} file, it will be read
24494 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
24495 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
24496 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
24497 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
24499 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
24500 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
24501 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
24505 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
24509 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
24512 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
24513 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
24516 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
24519 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
24520 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
24523 @include gnus-faq.texi
24543 @c Local Variables:
24545 @c coding: iso-8859-1
24547 % LocalWords: BNF mucho detailmenu cindex kindex kbd
24548 % LocalWords: findex Gnusae vindex dfn dfn samp nntp setq nnspool nntpserver
24549 % LocalWords: nnmbox newusers Blllrph NEWGROUPS dingnusdingnusdingnus
24550 % LocalWords: pre fab rec comp nnslashdot regex ga ga sci nnml nnbabyl nnmh
24551 % LocalWords: nnfolder emph looong eld newsreaders defun init elc pxref